blob: 9b748ccc34120b3c10dd8c33d84269bff6853b1b [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +020038who contributed the specific port. The boards.cfg file lists board
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010039maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000040
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000041Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
42it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
43
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
51U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
61The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
62git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
110
111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000113
114
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900135 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
136 /cpu CPU specific files
137 /arc700 Files specific to ARC 700 CPUs
138 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
140 /cpu CPU specific files
141 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
142 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000143 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200144 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
145 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
147 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500148 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500149 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
150 /lib Architecture specific library files
151 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /lib Architecture specific library files
154 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
155 /cpu CPU specific files
156 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500157 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
158 /cpu CPU specific files
159 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
160 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
161 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
162 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
163 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
164 /lib Architecture specific library files
165 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
166 /cpu CPU specific files
167 /lib Architecture specific library files
168 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
169 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200170 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900171 /mips64 Files specific to MIPS64 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500172 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000173 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
174 /cpu CPU specific files
175 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
176 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500177 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
178 /cpu CPU specific files
179 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400180 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
181 /cpu CPU specific files
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200183 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500184 /cpu CPU specific files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500185 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
186 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
187 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500188 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
189 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
190 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
191 /lib Architecture specific library files
192 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
193 /cpu CPU specific files
194 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
195 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
196 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
197 /lib Architecture specific library files
198 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
199 /cpu CPU specific files
200 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
201 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
202 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400203 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
204 /cpu CPU specific files
205 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500206/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
207/board Board dependent files
208/common Misc architecture independent functions
209/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
210/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
211/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400212/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500213/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
214/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
215/include Header Files
216/lib Files generic to all architectures
217 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
218 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
219 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
220/net Networking code
221/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400222/spl Secondary Program Loader framework
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500223/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000224
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000225Software Configuration:
226=======================
227
228Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
229rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
230
231There are two classes of configuration variables:
232
233* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
234 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
235 "CONFIG_".
236
237* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
238 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
239 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200240 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000241
242Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
243identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
244do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
245links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
246as an example here.
247
248
249Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
250---------------------------------------------------
251
252For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200253configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000254
255Example: For a TQM823L module type:
256
257 cd u-boot
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200258 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000259
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200260For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200261e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_defconfig". And also configure the cogent
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000262directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
263
264
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600265Sandbox Environment:
266--------------------
267
268U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
269board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
270specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
271run some of U-Boot's tests.
272
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki6b1978f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530273See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600274
275
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700276Board Initialisation Flow:
277--------------------------
278
279This is the intended start-up flow for boards. This should apply for both
280SPL and U-Boot proper (i.e. they both follow the same rules). At present SPL
281mostly uses a separate code path, but the funtion names and roles of each
282function are the same. Some boards or architectures may not conform to this.
283At least most ARM boards which use CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK conform to this.
284
285Execution starts with start.S with three functions called during init after
286that. The purpose and limitations of each is described below.
287
288lowlevel_init():
289 - purpose: essential init to permit execution to reach board_init_f()
290 - no global_data or BSS
291 - there is no stack (ARMv7 may have one but it will soon be removed)
292 - must not set up SDRAM or use console
293 - must only do the bare minimum to allow execution to continue to
294 board_init_f()
295 - this is almost never needed
296 - return normally from this function
297
298board_init_f():
299 - purpose: set up the machine ready for running board_init_r():
300 i.e. SDRAM and serial UART
301 - global_data is available
302 - stack is in SRAM
303 - BSS is not available, so you cannot use global/static variables,
304 only stack variables and global_data
305
306 Non-SPL-specific notes:
307 - dram_init() is called to set up DRAM. If already done in SPL this
308 can do nothing
309
310 SPL-specific notes:
311 - you can override the entire board_init_f() function with your own
312 version as needed.
313 - preloader_console_init() can be called here in extremis
314 - should set up SDRAM, and anything needed to make the UART work
315 - these is no need to clear BSS, it will be done by crt0.S
316 - must return normally from this function (don't call board_init_r()
317 directly)
318
319Here the BSS is cleared. For SPL, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined, then at
320this point the stack and global_data are relocated to below
321CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR. For non-SPL, U-Boot is relocated to run at the top of
322memory.
323
324board_init_r():
325 - purpose: main execution, common code
326 - global_data is available
327 - SDRAM is available
328 - BSS is available, all static/global variables can be used
329 - execution eventually continues to main_loop()
330
331 Non-SPL-specific notes:
332 - U-Boot is relocated to the top of memory and is now running from
333 there.
334
335 SPL-specific notes:
336 - stack is optionally in SDRAM, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined and
337 CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR points into SDRAM
338 - preloader_console_init() can be called here - typically this is
339 done by defining CONFIG_SPL_BOARD_INIT and then supplying a
340 spl_board_init() function containing this call
341 - loads U-Boot or (in falcon mode) Linux
342
343
344
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000345Configuration Options:
346----------------------
347
348Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
349such information is kept in a configuration file
350"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
351
352Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
353"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
354
355
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000356Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
357kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
358build a config tool - later.
359
360
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000361The following options need to be configured:
362
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500363- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000364
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500365- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200366
367- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100368 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000369
370- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
371 Define exactly one of
372 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
373--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
374 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
375 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
376
377- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
378 Define exactly one of
379 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
380
381- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
382 Define one or more of
383 CONFIG_CMA302
384
385- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
386 Define one or more of
387 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200388 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000389 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
390
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530391- Marvell Family Member
392 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
393 multiple fs option at one time
394 for marvell soc family
395
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200396- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000397 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
398 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000399 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
400 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000401 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
402 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000403
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000404- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200405 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
406 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000407 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000408 See doc/README.MPC866
409
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200410 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000411
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000412 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
413 of relying on the correctness of the configured
414 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
415 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
416 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200417 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000418
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100419 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
420
421 Define this option if you want to enable the
422 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
423
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600424- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000425 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
426
427 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
428 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
429 compliance, among other possible reasons.
430
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600431 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
432
433 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
434 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
435 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
436
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500437 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
438
439 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
440 tree nodes for the given platform.
441
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000442 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
443
444 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
445 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
446 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
447 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
448 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
449 purpose.
450
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000451 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
452
453 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
454 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
455 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
456
457 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
458 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
459
460 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
461 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
462
463 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
464 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
465 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
466 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
467
468 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
469 this erratum.
470
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530471 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
472 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800473 required during NOR boot.
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530474
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530475 CONFIG_A008044_WORKAROUND
476 Enables a workaround for T1040/T1042 erratum A008044. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800477 required during NAND boot and valid for Rev 1.0 SoC revision
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530478
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000479 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
480
481 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
482 according to the A004510 workaround.
483
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530484 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
485 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
486 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
487
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530488 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
489 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
490 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
491
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530492 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
493 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
494 connected to the DSP core.
495
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530496 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
497 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
498
Priyanka Jainb1359912013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530499 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
500 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
501 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
502 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
503
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530504 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
505 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
506 time of U-boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
507
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800508 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800509 Indicates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800510 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
511
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000512- Generic CPU options:
York Sun2a1680e2014-05-02 17:28:04 -0700513 CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_GLOBAL_DATA
514 Defines global data is initialized in generic board board_init_f().
515 If this macro is defined, global data is created and cleared in
516 generic board board_init_f(). Without this macro, architecture/board
517 should initialize global data before calling board_init_f().
518
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000519 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
520
521 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
522 values is arch specific.
523
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700524 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
525 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
526 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
527 SoCs.
528
529 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
530 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
531
532 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
533 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
534 deskew training are not available.
535
536 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
537 Freescale DDR1 controller.
538
539 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
540 Freescale DDR2 controller.
541
542 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
543 Freescale DDR3 controller.
544
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700545 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
546 Freescale DDR4 controller.
547
York Sun9ac4ffb2013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700548 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
549 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
550
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700551 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
552 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
553 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
554 implemetation.
555
556 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
557 Board config to use DDR2. It can be eanbeld for SoCs with
558 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
559 implementation.
560
561 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
562 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700563 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
564
565 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
566 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
567 DDR3L controllers.
568
569 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
570 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
571 DDR4 controllers.
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700572
Prabhakar Kushwaha1b4175d2014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530573 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
574 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
575
576 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
577 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
578
Prabhakar Kushwaha690e4252014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530579 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
580 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
581 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
582
583 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
584 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
585 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
586 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
587
Prabhakar Kushwaha89ad7be2014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530588 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
589 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
590 concatenated with u-boot binary.
591
York Sun4e5b1bd2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800592 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
593 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
594
595 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
596 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
597
York Sun6b9e3092014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800598 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
599 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
600 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
601 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
602
York Sun6b1e1252014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800603 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
604 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
605 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
606 SoCs with ARM core.
607
York Sun1d71efb2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700608 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
609 Number of controllers used as main memory.
610
611 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
612 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
613
Ruchika Gupta028dbb82014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530614 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
615 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
616
617 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
618 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
619
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100620- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200621 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100622
623 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
624 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
625 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
626
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200627 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200628
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100629 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
630 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200631 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100632 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200633
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200634- MIPS CPU options:
635 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
636
637 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
638 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
639 relocation.
640
641 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
642
643 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
644 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
645 Possible values are:
646 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
647 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
648 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
649 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
650 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
651 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
652 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
653 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
654
655 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
656
657 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
658 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
659
660 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
661
662 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
663 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
664 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
665
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000666- ARM options:
667 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
668
669 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
670 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
671
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000672 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
673
674 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
675 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
676 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
677 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
678 GCC.
679
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000680 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000681 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
682 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
683 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
Nitin Gargf71cbfe2014-04-02 08:55:01 -0500684 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_794072
Nitin Gargb7588e32014-04-02 08:55:02 -0500685 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_761320
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000686
687 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
688 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
689 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
690 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
691 set these options unless they apply!
692
Nishanth Menonc616a0d2015-03-09 17:11:59 -0500693 NOTE: The following can be machine specific errata. These
694 do have ability to provide rudimentary version and machine
695 specific checks, but expect no product checks.
Nishanth Menon5902f4c2015-03-09 17:12:01 -0500696 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_430973
Nishanth Menonb45c48a2015-03-09 17:12:00 -0500697 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_454179
Nishanth Menon9b4d65f2015-03-09 17:12:02 -0500698 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_621766
Nishanth Menonc616a0d2015-03-09 17:11:59 -0500699 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_798870
700
Stephen Warren73c38932015-01-19 16:25:52 -0700701- Tegra SoC options:
702 CONFIG_TEGRA_SUPPORT_NON_SECURE
703
704 Support executing U-Boot in non-secure (NS) mode. Certain
705 impossible actions will be skipped if the CPU is in NS mode,
706 such as ARM architectural timer initialization.
707
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000708- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000709 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
710
711 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
712 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
713 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
714 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
715 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
716 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
717 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000718 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100719 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000720 default environment.
721
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000722 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
723
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800724 When transferring memsize parameter to Linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000725 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
726 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
727
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400728 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200729
730 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400731 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
732 concepts).
733
734 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
735 * New libfdt-based support
736 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500737 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400738
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200739 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
740 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
741 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
742 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200743 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600744 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200745
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200746 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
747 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500748
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600749 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
750
751 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
752 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000753
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -0600754 CONFIG_OF_SYSTEM_SETUP
755
756 Other code has addition modification that it wants to make
757 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel.
758 This causes ft_system_setup() to be called before booting
759 the kernel.
760
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500761 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
762
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200763 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500764 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
765
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200766 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
767
768 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
769 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
770 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
771 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
772 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
773 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
774
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000775 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
776
777 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
778 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
779 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
780 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
781 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
782 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
783 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
784
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100785- vxWorks boot parameters:
786
787 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
788 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
789 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
790
791 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
792 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
793 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
794 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
795
796 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
797
798 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
799
800 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
801 the defaults discussed just above.
802
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000803- Cache Configuration:
804 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
805 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
806 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
807
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000808- Cache Configuration for ARM:
809 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
810 controller
811 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
812 controller register space
813
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000814- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200815 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000816
817 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
818
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200819 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000820
821 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
822
823 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
824
825 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
826 the clock speed of the UARTs.
827
828 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
829
830 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
831 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
832 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
833
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000834 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
835
836 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
837 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
838 this variable to initialize the extra register.
839
840 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
841
842 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
843 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
844 variable to flush the UART at init time.
845
Karicheri, Muralidharand57dee52014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400846 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
847
848 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
849 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000850
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000851- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000852 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
853 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
854 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
855 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000856
857 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
858 port routines must be defined elsewhere
859 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
860
861 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
862 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000863 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000864 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
865 (default big endian)
866 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
867 rectangle fill
868 (cf. smiLynxEM)
869 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
870 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
871 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
872 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000873 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
874 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000875 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
876 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000877 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000878 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
879 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
880 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
881 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
882 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
883 (i.e. i8042_getc)
884 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
885 (requires blink timer
886 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200887 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000888 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
889 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500890 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000891 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
892 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000893 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
894 linux_logo.h for logo.
895 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000896 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200897 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000898 the logo
899
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000900 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
901 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
902 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
903
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000904 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
905 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
906 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000907
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000908 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
909 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
910 the "silent" environment variable. See
911 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000912
Heiko Schocher45ae2542013-10-22 11:06:06 +0200913 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BG_COL: define the backgroundcolor, default
914 is 0x00.
915 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_FG_COL: define the foregroundcolor, default
916 is 0xa0.
917
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000918- Console Baudrate:
919 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
920 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200921 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
922 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000923
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100924- Console Rx buffer length
925 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
926 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100927 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100928 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
929 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
930 the SMC.
931
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000932- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200933 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
934 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
935 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
936 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
937 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
938 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
939 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200940 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200941 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000942
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200943 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
944 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000945
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000946- Safe printf() functions
947 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
948 the printf() functions. These are defined in
949 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
950 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
951 If this option is not given then these functions will
952 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
953 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
954
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000955- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
956 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
957 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000958 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
959 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000960
961 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
962 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
963 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
964 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
965 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
966 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
967 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
968 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
969 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
970 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
971 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
972 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
973
974- Autoboot Command:
975 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
976 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
977 define a command string that is automatically executed
978 when no character is read on the console interface
979 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
980
981 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000982 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
983 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
984 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000985
986 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000987 The value of these goes into the environment as
988 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
989 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200990 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000991
Heiko Schochereda0ba32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100992- Bootcount:
993 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
994 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
995 cycle, see:
996 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
997
998 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
999 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
1000 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
1001 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
1002 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
1003 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
1004 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
1005 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
1006 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
1007
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001008- Pre-Boot Commands:
1009 CONFIG_PREBOOT
1010
1011 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
1012 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
1013 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
1014 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
1015 entering interactive mode.
1016
1017 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
1018 automatically generated or modified. For an example
1019 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
1020 modified when the user holds down a certain
1021 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
1022 booting the systems
1023
1024- Serial Download Echo Mode:
1025 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
1026 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
1027 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
1028 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
1029 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
1030 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
1031 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
1032
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001033- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001034 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
1035 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001036 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001037
1038- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001039 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
1040 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +00001041 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
1042 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001043 and augmenting with additional #define's
1044 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001045
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001046 The default command configuration includes all commands
1047 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001048
Marek Vasutb401b732014-03-05 19:58:39 +01001049 CONFIG_CMD_AES AES 128 CBC encrypt/decrypt
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001050 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001051 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
1052 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
1053 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
1054 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
1055 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
Tom Rinid2b2ffe2014-08-14 06:42:36 -04001056 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTI * ARM64 Linux kernel Image support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001057 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
Michal Simek08d0d6f2013-11-21 13:39:02 -08001058 CONFIG_CMD_CLK * clock command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001059 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -05001060 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001061 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
1062 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
1063 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -06001064 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
1065 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
1066 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
1067 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001068 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
1069 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -05001070 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001071 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
1072 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -06001073 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -06001074 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Andrew Ruder88733e22013-10-22 19:07:34 -05001075 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_EXISTS * check existence of env variable
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001076 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001077 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
1078 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Stephen Warren16f4d932014-01-24 20:46:37 -07001079 CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC * filesystem commands (e.g. load, ls)
1080 that work for multiple fs types
Christian Gmeiner59e890e2014-11-12 14:35:04 +01001081 CONFIG_CMD_FS_UUID * Look up a filesystem UUID
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -05001082 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001083 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001084 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001085 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
1086 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001087 CONFIG_CMD_FUSE * Device fuse support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +00001088 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -05001089 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +00001090 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00001091 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001092 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
1093 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
1094 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
1095 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +00001096 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001097 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND * List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001098 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001099 CONFIG_CMD_IOTRACE * I/O tracing for debugging
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001100 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +00001101 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001102 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
1103 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
1104 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
1105 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001106 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO * ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001107 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
1108 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001109 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
1110 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001111 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM * print md5 message digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001112 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +00001113 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001114 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +00001115 loop, loopw
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001116 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST * mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001117 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
1118 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
1119 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +01001120 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001121 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
1122 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001123 CONFIG_CMD_NFS NFS support
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001124 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001125 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001126 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
1127 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
1128 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
1129 host
1130 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +00001131 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001132 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
1133 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +00001134 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001135 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
1136 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
1137 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
1138 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
1139 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
1140 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07001141 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001142 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM * print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001143 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Bob Liu7d861d92013-02-05 19:05:41 +08001144 CONFIG_CMD_SOFTSWITCH * Soft switch setting command for BF60x
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02001145 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001146 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +00001147 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00001148 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +00001149 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
1150 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001151 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001152 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +00001153 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001154 CONFIG_CMD_XIMG Load part of Multi Image
Przemyslaw Marczak89c82302014-04-02 10:20:05 +02001155 CONFIG_CMD_UUID * Generate random UUID or GUID string
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001156
1157 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
1158 support you can write:
1159
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001160 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
1161 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001162
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -04001163 Other Commands:
1164 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001165
1166 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001167 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001168 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
1169 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
1170 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
1171 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
1172 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
1173 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001174
1175
1176 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
1177
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001178- Regular expression support:
1179 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001180 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
1181 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
1182 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
1183 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001184
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001185- Device tree:
1186 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
1187 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
1188 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
1189 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
1190 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
1191 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
1192
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001193 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
1194 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +00001195
1196 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
1197 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
1198 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
1199 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
1200 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
1201 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001202
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001203 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
1204 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
1205 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
1206 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
1207
1208 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
1209
1210 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
1211 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
1212 still use the individual files if you need something more
1213 exotic.
1214
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001215- Watchdog:
1216 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
1217 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00001218 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
1219 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
1220 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
1221 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
1222 available, then no further board specific code should
1223 be needed to use it.
1224
1225 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
1226 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
1227 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
1228 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001229
Heiko Schocher7bae0d62015-01-21 08:38:22 +01001230 CONFIG_AT91_HW_WDT_TIMEOUT
1231 specify the timeout in seconds. default 2 seconds.
1232
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001233- U-Boot Version:
1234 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
1235 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
1236 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
1237 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e512012-08-13 15:01:14 +02001238 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
1239 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001240
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001241- Real-Time Clock:
1242
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001243 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001244 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
1245 following options:
1246
1247 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1248 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001249 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001250 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001251 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001252 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001253 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel412921d2014-07-21 11:06:16 +02001254 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001255 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001256 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001257 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001258 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001259 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1260 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001261
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001262 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1263 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1264
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001265- GPIO Support:
1266 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001267
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001268 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1269 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1270 pins supported by a particular chip.
1271
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001272 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1273 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1274
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001275- I/O tracing:
1276 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
1277 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
1278 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
1279 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
1280 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
1281 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
1282 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
1283 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
1284
1285 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
1286 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
1287 still continue to operate.
1288
1289 iotrace is enabled
1290 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
1291 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
1292 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
1293 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
1294 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
1295 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
1296
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001297- Timestamp Support:
1298
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001299 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1300 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1301 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001302 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001303
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001304- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1305 Zero or more of the following:
1306 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1307 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1308 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1309 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1310 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1311 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1312 disk/part_efi.c
1313 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001314
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001315 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1316 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001317 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001318
1319- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001320 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1321 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001322
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001323 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1324 be performed by calling the function
1325 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1326 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001327
1328- ATAPI Support:
1329 CONFIG_ATAPI
1330
1331 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1332
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001333- LBA48 Support
1334 CONFIG_LBA48
1335
1336 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001337 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001338 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1339 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1340
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001341 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001342 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1343 Default is 32bit.
1344
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001345- SCSI Support:
1346 At the moment only there is only support for the
1347 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1348 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1349
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001350 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1351 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1352 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001353 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1354 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001355 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001356
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001357 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1358 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001359
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001360- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001361 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001362 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1363
1364 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1365 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1366 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1367 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1368
1369 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1370 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1371 example with the "sspi" command.
1372
1373 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1374 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1375 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001376
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001377 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001378 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001379
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001380 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1381 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001382 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001383 write routine for first time initialisation.
1384
1385 CONFIG_TULIP
1386 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1387 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1388 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1389
1390 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1391 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1392
1393 CONFIG_NS8382X
1394 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1395
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001396- NETWORK Support (other):
1397
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001398 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1399 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1400
1401 CONFIG_RMII
1402 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1403
1404 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1405 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1406 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1407
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001408 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1409 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1410
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001411 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001412 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1413
1414 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1415 Define this to hold the physical address
1416 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1417
1418 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1419 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1420
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001421 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001422 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1423
1424 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1425 Define this to hold the physical address
1426 of the device (I/O space)
1427
1428 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1429 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1430
1431 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1432 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1433 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1434
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001435 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1436 Support for davinci emac
1437
1438 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1439 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1440
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001441 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1442 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1443
1444 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1445 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1446 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1447 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1448 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1449 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1450 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1451 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1452
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001453 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001454 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1455
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001456 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001457 Define this to hold the physical address
1458 of the device (I/O space)
1459
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001460 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001461 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1462
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001463 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001464 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1465 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001466 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001467
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001468 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1469 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1470
1471 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1472 Define the number of ports to be used
1473
1474 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1475 Define the ETH PHY's address
1476
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001477 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1478 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1479
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001480- PWM Support:
1481 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
1482 Support for PWM modul on the imx6.
1483
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001484- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001485 CONFIG_TPM
1486 Support TPM devices.
1487
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001488 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C
1489 Support for i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
1490 per system is supported at this time.
1491
1492 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BUS_NUMBER
1493 Define the the i2c bus number for the TPM device
1494
1495 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS
1496 Define the TPM's address on the i2c bus
1497
1498 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1499 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1500
Dirk Eibachc01939c2013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001501 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1502 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1503
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001504 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001505 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1506 per system is supported at this time.
1507
1508 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1509 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1510 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1511 0xfed40000.
1512
Reinhard Pfaube6c1522013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001513 CONFIG_CMD_TPM
1514 Add tpm monitor functions.
1515 Requires CONFIG_TPM. If CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS is set, also
1516 provides monitor access to authorized functions.
1517
1518 CONFIG_TPM
1519 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1520 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1521 Requires support for a TPM device.
1522
1523 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1524 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1525 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1526
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001527- USB Support:
1528 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001529 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001530 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1531 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001532 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001533 storage devices.
1534 Note:
1535 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1536 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001537 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1538 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1539 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001540 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1541 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001542 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1543 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1544 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001545 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1546 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001547 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001548 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1549 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001550
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001551 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1552 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1553
Oleksandr Tymoshenko6e9e0622014-02-01 21:51:25 -07001554 CONFIG_USB_DWC2_REG_ADDR the physical CPU address of the DWC2
1555 HW module registers.
1556
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001557- USB Device:
1558 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1559 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1560 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001561 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001562 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1563 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001564 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001565 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1566 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1567 a Linux host by
1568 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1569 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1570 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1571 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001572
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001573 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1574 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001575
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001576 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1577 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1578 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001579
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301580 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1581 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1582 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1583 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1584 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1585 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1586 speed.
1587
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001588 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001589 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1590 be set to usbtty.
1591
1592 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001593 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001594 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001595 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001596
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001597 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001598 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001599 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001600
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001601 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001602 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001603 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001604 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1605 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1606 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1607
1608 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1609 Define this string as the name of your company for
1610 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001611
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001612 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1613 Define this string as the name of your product
1614 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1615
1616 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1617 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1618 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1619 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1620 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001621
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001622 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1623 Define this as the unique Product ID
1624 for your device
1625 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001626
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001627- ULPI Layer Support:
1628 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1629 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1630 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1631 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1632 viewport is supported.
1633 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1634 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001635 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1636 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1637 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001638
1639- MMC Support:
1640 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1641 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1642 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1643 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001644 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1645 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001646
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001647 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1648 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1649
1650 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1651 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1652
1653 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1654 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1655
Pierre Aubert1fd93c62014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001656 CONFIG_GENERIC_MMC
1657 Enable the generic MMC driver
1658
1659 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1660 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1661
1662 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
1663 Enable the commands for reading, writing and programming the
1664 key for the Replay Protection Memory Block partition in eMMC.
1665
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001666- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
1667 CONFIG_DFU_FUNCTION
1668 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1669
1670 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1671 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1672 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1673 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1674 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1675
1676 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1677 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1678
Pantelis Antoniouc6631762013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001679 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1680 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1681
Afzal Mohammeda9479f02013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301682 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1683 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1684 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1685 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1686 one that would help mostly the developer.
1687
Heiko Schochere7e75c72013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001688 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1689 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1690 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1691 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1692 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1693
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001694 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1695 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1696 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1697 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1698 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1699 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1700
Heiko Schocher001a8312014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001701 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1702 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1703 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1704 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1705
1706 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1707 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1708 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1709 sending again an USB request to the device.
1710
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001711- USB Device Android Fastboot support:
1712 CONFIG_CMD_FASTBOOT
1713 This enables the command "fastboot" which enables the Android
1714 fastboot mode for the platform's USB device. Fastboot is a USB
1715 protocol for downloading images, flashing and device control
1716 used on Android devices.
1717 See doc/README.android-fastboot for more information.
1718
1719 CONFIG_ANDROID_BOOT_IMAGE
1720 This enables support for booting images which use the Android
1721 image format header.
1722
1723 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_ADDR
1724 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1725 downloads. Define this to the starting RAM address to use for
1726 downloaded images.
1727
1728 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_SIZE
1729 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1730 downloads. This buffer should be as large as possible for a
1731 platform. Define this to the size available RAM for fastboot.
1732
Steve Raed1b5ed02014-08-26 11:47:28 -07001733 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH
1734 The fastboot protocol includes a "flash" command for writing
1735 the downloaded image to a non-volatile storage device. Define
1736 this to enable the "fastboot flash" command.
1737
1738 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV
1739 The fastboot "flash" command requires additional information
1740 regarding the non-volatile storage device. Define this to
1741 the eMMC device that fastboot should use to store the image.
1742
Steve Rae0ff7e582014-12-12 15:51:54 -08001743 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_GPT_NAME
1744 The fastboot "flash" command supports writing the downloaded
1745 image to the Protective MBR and the Primary GUID Partition
1746 Table. (Additionally, this downloaded image is post-processed
1747 to generate and write the Backup GUID Partition Table.)
1748 This occurs when the specified "partition name" on the
1749 "fastboot flash" command line matches this value.
1750 Default is GPT_ENTRY_NAME (currently "gpt") if undefined.
1751
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001752- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1753 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1754 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1755 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1756
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001757 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1758 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001759 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1760
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001761 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001762 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1763 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1764
1765 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001766 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001767 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1768 have not defined a custom partition
1769
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001770- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1771 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001772
1773 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1774 file in FAT formatted partition.
1775
1776 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1777 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001778
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001779CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1780 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1781
1782 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1783 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1784 and cbfsload.
1785
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu4f0d1a22014-05-26 19:18:37 +05301786- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem cluster size:
1787 CONFIG_FS_FAT_MAX_CLUSTSIZE
1788
1789 Define the max cluster size for fat operations else
1790 a default value of 65536 will be defined.
1791
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001792- Keyboard Support:
1793 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1794
1795 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1796 support
1797
1798 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1799 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1800 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1801 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1802 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1803
Hung-ying Tyan713cb682013-05-15 18:27:32 +08001804 CONFIG_CROS_EC_KEYB
1805 Enables a Chrome OS keyboard using the CROS_EC interface.
1806 This uses CROS_EC to communicate with a second microcontroller
1807 which provides key scans on request.
1808
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001809- Video support:
1810 CONFIG_VIDEO
1811
1812 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1813 video).
1814
1815 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1816
1817 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1818
1819 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001820 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001821 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1822 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1823 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001824
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001825 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001826 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001827 are possible:
1828 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001829 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001830
1831 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1832 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1833 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1834 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1835 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1836 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1837 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001838 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1839
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001840 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001841 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001842
1843
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001844 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001845 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001846 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1847 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1848
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001849 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001850 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001851 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1852 support, and should also define these other macros:
1853
1854 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1855 CONFIG_VIDEO
1856 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1857 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1858 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1859 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1860 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1861 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1862
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001863 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1864 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1865 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1866 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001867
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001868 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1869
1870 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1871 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1872 driver.
1873
1874
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001875- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001876 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001877
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001878 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1879 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1880 defined in your board-specific files.
1881 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001882
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001883- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1884
1885 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1886 display); also select one of the supported displays
1887 by defining one of these:
1888
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001889 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1890
1891 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1892
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001893 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001894
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001895 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001896
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001897 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001898
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001899 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1900 Active, color, single scan.
1901
1902 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1903
1904 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001905 Active, color, single scan.
1906
1907 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1908
1909 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1910 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1911
1912 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1913
1914 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1915 Active, color, single scan.
1916
1917 CONFIG_HLD1045
1918
1919 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1920 Active, color, single scan.
1921
1922 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1923
1924 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1925 or
1926 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1927 or
1928 Hitachi SP14Q002
1929
1930 320x240. Black & white.
1931
1932 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001933 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001934
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001935 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1936
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001937 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (typically 4KB). If this is
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001938 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1939 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1940 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1941 a per-section basis.
1942
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001943 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1944
1945 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1946 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1947 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1948 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001949
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001950 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1951
1952 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1953
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001954 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1955
1956 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1957 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1958
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001959- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001960
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001961 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1962 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1963 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001964 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001965 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1966 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1967 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1968 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001969
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001970 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1971
1972 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1973 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Tom Rini1551df32014-02-25 10:27:01 -05001974 (see README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001975 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1976 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1977 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1978 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1979 there is no need to set this option.
1980
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001981 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1982
1983 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1984 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1985 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1986 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1987 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1988 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1989
1990 Example:
1991 setenv splashpos m,m
1992 => image at center of screen
1993
1994 setenv splashpos 30,20
1995 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1996
1997 setenv splashpos -10,m
1998 => vertically centered image
1999 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
2000
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02002001- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
2002
2003 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
2004 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
2005 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
2006
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01002007- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
2008
2009 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
2010 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
2011 bmp command.
2012
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002013- Do compressing for memory range:
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00002014 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
2015
2016 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
2017 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
2018
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00002019- Compression support:
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07002020 CONFIG_GZIP
2021
2022 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
2023
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00002024 CONFIG_BZIP2
2025
2026 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
2027 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
2028 compressed images are supported.
2029
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002030 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002031 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002032 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00002033
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02002034 CONFIG_LZMA
2035
2036 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
2037 images is included.
2038
2039 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
2040 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
2041 formula:
2042
2043 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
2044
2045 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
2046 and Literal pos bits.
2047
2048 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
2049 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
2050 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
2051 a very small buffer.
2052
2053 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
2054 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002055 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02002056
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07002057 CONFIG_LZO
2058
2059 If this option is set, support for LZO compressed images
2060 is included.
2061
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002062- MII/PHY support:
2063 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
2064
2065 The address of PHY on MII bus.
2066
2067 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
2068
2069 The clock frequency of the MII bus
2070
2071 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
2072
2073 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002074 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002075
2076 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
2077
2078 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
2079 reset before any MII register access is possible.
2080 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
2081 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
2082
2083 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
2084
2085 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
2086 command issued before MII status register can be read
2087
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002088- Ethernet address:
2089 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04002090 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002091 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
2092 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04002093 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
2094 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002095
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002096 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
2097 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002098 is not determined automatically.
2099
2100- IP address:
2101 CONFIG_IPADDR
2102
2103 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002104 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002105 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002106 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002107
2108- Server IP address:
2109 CONFIG_SERVERIP
2110
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002111 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002112 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002113 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002114
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04002115 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
2116
2117 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
2118 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
2119
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002120- Gateway IP address:
2121 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
2122
2123 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
2124 default router where packets to other networks are
2125 sent to.
2126 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
2127
2128- Subnet mask:
2129 CONFIG_NETMASK
2130
2131 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
2132 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
2133 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
2134 forwarded through a router.
2135 (Environment variable "netmask")
2136
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002137- Multicast TFTP Mode:
2138 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
2139
2140 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
2141 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002142 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002143 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
2144 multicast group.
2145
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002146- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
2147 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
2148
2149 If you have many targets in a network that try to
2150 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
2151 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
2152 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
2153 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
2154 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
2155 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
2156 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02002157 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002158
2159 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
2160 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
2161 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
2162 4th and following
2163 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
2164
Thierry Reding92ac8ac2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02002165 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
2166
2167 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
2168 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
2169 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
2170 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
2171 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
2172 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
2173 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
2174 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
2175 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
2176 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
2177 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
2178 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
2179 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
2180 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
2181 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
2182
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002183- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002184 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
2185 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002186
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002187 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
2188 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
2189 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
2190 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
2191 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
2192 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
2193 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
2194 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
2195 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
2196 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
2197 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
2198 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002199 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002200
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002201 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
2202 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002203
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002204 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
2205 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
2206 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
2207 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
2208 is not available.
2209
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002210 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
2211 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
2212 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
2213 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
2214 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
2215 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
2216 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002217 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002218
2219 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
2220 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
2221 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002222 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002223 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
2224 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002225
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11002226 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
2227
2228 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
2229 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
2230 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
2231 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
2232 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
2233 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
2234 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
2235 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
2236 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
2237 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
2238 this delay.
2239
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00002240 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
2241 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
2242 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
2243 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
2244 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
2245
2246 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
2247
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002248 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00002249 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002250
2251 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
2252
2253 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
2254
2255 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
2256 of the device.
2257
2258 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
2259
2260 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
2261 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002262 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002263
2264 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
2265
2266 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
2267 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
2268
2269 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
2270
2271 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
2272
2273 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
2274
2275 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
2276
2277 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
2278
2279 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
2280
2281 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
2282
2283 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
2284 device in .1 of milliwatts.
2285
2286 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
2287
2288 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
2289
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002290- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
2291
2292 Several configurations allow to display the current
2293 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
2294 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
2295 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
2296 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
2297 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
2298 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
2299 feature in U-Boot.
2300
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02002301 Additional options:
2302
2303 CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2304 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
2305 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
2306 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2307 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
2308
Igor Grinberg9dfdcdf2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02002309 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
2310 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
2311 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
2312 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
2313 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
2314 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
2315
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002316- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
2317
2318 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
2319 on those systems that support this (optional)
2320 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
2321
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002322- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002323
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002324 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
2325 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
2326 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
2327 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
2328 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
2329 interface.
2330
2331 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002332 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
2333 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
2334 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
2335 for defining speed and slave address
2336 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
2337 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
2338 for defining speed and slave address
2339 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
2340 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
2341 for defining speed and slave address
2342 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
2343 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
2344 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002345
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002346 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
2347 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
2348 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
2349 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
2350 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
2351 bus.
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002352 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002353 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
2354 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
2355 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
2356 second bus.
2357
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002358 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu10cee512013-10-11 16:23:53 +09002359 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
2360 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
2361 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002362
Dirk Eibach880540d2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00002363 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
2364 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
2365 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2366 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2367
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002368 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
2369 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
2370 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
2371 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
2372 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
2373 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
2374 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
2375 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002376 If those defines are not set, default value is 100000
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002377 for speed, and 0 for slave.
2378
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1086bfa2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09002379 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
2380 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
2381 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
2382
2383 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
2384 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
2385 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
2386 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
2387 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
2388 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
2389 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
2390 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
2391 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
2392
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002393 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
2394 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
2395 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
2396
2397 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
2398 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
2399 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
2400 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
2401 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
2402 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
2403 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
2404 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
2405 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
2406 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
2407 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE5 for setting the register channel 5
2408 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED5 for for the speed channel 5
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002409 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002410
Heiko Schocher6789e842013-10-22 11:03:18 +02002411 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
2412 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
2413 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
2414 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
2415 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
2416 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
2417 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
2418 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
2419 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
2420 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
2421 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
2422 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
2423
Heiko Schocher0bdffe72013-11-08 07:30:53 +01002424 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
2425 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
2426 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
2427 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
2428
Naveen Krishna Che717fc62013-12-06 12:12:38 +05302429 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
2430 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
2431 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
2432 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
2433 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
2434
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02002435 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
2436 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
2437 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2438 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
2439 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
2440 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2441 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
2442 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
2443 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
2444 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
2445 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
2446 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
2447 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
2448 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
2449
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002450 additional defines:
2451
2452 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002453 Hold the number of i2c buses you want to use. If you
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002454 don't use/have i2c muxes on your i2c bus, this
2455 is equal to CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_ADAPTERS, and you can
2456 omit this define.
2457
2458 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
2459 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
2460 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
2461 omit this define.
2462
2463 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
2464 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
2465 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
2466 define.
2467
2468 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002469 hold a list of buses you want to use, only used if
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002470 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
2471 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
2472 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
2473
2474 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2475 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
2476 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
2477 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
2478 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
2479 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
2480 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2481 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
2482 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
2483 }
2484
2485 which defines
2486 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002487 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
2488 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
2489 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
2490 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
2491 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002492 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002493 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
2494 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002495
2496 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
2497
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002498- Legacy I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002499
2500 NOTE: It is intended to move drivers to CONFIG_SYS_I2C which
2501 provides the following compelling advantages:
2502
2503 - more than one i2c adapter is usable
2504 - approved multibus support
2505 - better i2c mux support
2506
2507 ** Please consider updating your I2C driver now. **
2508
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002509 These enable legacy I2C serial bus commands. Defining
2510 CONFIG_HARD_I2C will include the appropriate I2C driver
2511 for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002512
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002513 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05002514 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002515 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
2516 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002517 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002518
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002519 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002520
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002521 There are several other quantities that must also be
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002522 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002523
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002524 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002525 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002526 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002527 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002528
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002529 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002530 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002531 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
2532 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
2533 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002534
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05002535 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
2536
2537 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2538 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2539 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
2540 commands until the slave device responds.
2541
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002542 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002543
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002544 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002545 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
2546 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002547
2548 I2C_INIT
2549
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002550 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002551 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002552
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002553 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002554
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002555 I2C_PORT
2556
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002557 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
2558 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
2559 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002560
2561 I2C_ACTIVE
2562
2563 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
2564 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
2565 define can be null.
2566
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002567 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
2568
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002569 I2C_TRISTATE
2570
2571 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
2572 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
2573 define can be null.
2574
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002575 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
2576
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002577 I2C_READ
2578
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002579 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
2580 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002581
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002582 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
2583
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002584 I2C_SDA(bit)
2585
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002586 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
2587 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002588
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002589 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002590 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002591 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002592
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002593 I2C_SCL(bit)
2594
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002595 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
2596 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002597
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002598 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002599 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002600 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002601
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002602 I2C_DELAY
2603
2604 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
2605 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002606 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002607 like:
2608
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002609 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002610
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002611 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2612
2613 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2614 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2615 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2616 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2617
2618 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2619 the generic GPIO functions.
2620
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002621 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002622
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002623 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2624 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2625 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2626 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2627 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2628 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2629 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2630 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002631
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002632 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2633
2634 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2635 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2636 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2637 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2638 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2639 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2640 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2641 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2642
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002643 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2644
2645 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2646 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2647 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2648
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002649 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2650
2651 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002652 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2653 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002654 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2655
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002656 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002657
2658 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002659 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002660 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2661 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002662
2663 e.g.
2664 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002665 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002666
2667 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2668
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002669 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002670 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002671
2672 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2673
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002674 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002675
2676 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2677 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2678
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002679 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002680
2681 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2682 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2683
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002684 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002685
2686 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2687 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2688
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002689 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002690
2691 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2692 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2693 specified DTT device.
2694
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002695 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2696
2697 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2698 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2699 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2700 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2701 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2702 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2703 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002704
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002705- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2706
2707 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2708 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2709 D/As on the SACSng board)
2710
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002711 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2712
2713 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2714 only SH7757 is supported.
2715
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002716 CONFIG_SPI_X
2717
2718 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2719 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2720
2721 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2722
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002723 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2724 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2725 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2726 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2727 defined, the board configuration must define several
2728 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2729 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002730
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002731 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2732
2733 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2734 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2735 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002736 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002737 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2738
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002739 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2740
2741 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002742 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002743
Heiko Schocherf659b572014-07-14 10:22:11 +02002744 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
2745 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
2746 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
2747
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002748- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2749
2750 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2751
2752 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2753
2754 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2755 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2756
2757 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2758
2759 Enables support for FPGA family.
2760 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2761
2762 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002763
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002764 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002765
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu64e809a2014-03-14 16:35:38 +05302766 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADMK
2767
2768 Enable support for fpga loadmk command
2769
Michal Simek67193862014-05-02 13:43:39 +02002770 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADP
2771
2772 Enable support for fpga loadp command - load partial bitstream
2773
2774 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADBP
2775
2776 Enable support for fpga loadbp command - load partial bitstream
2777 (Xilinx only)
2778
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002779 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002780
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002781 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002782
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002783 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002784
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002785 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2786 status by the configuration function. This option
2787 will require a board or device specific function to
2788 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002789
2790 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2791
2792 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2793 configuration driver.
2794
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002795 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002796 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2797
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002798 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002799
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002800 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2801 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2802 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2803 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002804
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002805 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002806
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002807 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to de-assert
2808 after PROB_B has been de-asserted during a Virtex II
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002809 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002810 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002811
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002812 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002813
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002814 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to de-assert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002815 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002816
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002817 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002818
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002819 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002820 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002821
2822- Configuration Management:
Stefan Roeseb2b8a692014-10-22 12:13:24 +02002823 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET
2824
2825 Some SoCs need special image types (e.g. U-Boot binary
2826 with a special header) as build targets. By defining
2827 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET in the SoC / board header, this
2828 special image will be automatically built upon calling
2829 make / MAKEALL.
2830
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002831 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2832
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002833 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2834 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002835
2836- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2837
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002838 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2839 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002840 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002841 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2842 protects these variables from casual modification by
2843 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2844 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002845 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002846
2847 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2848 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002849 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002850 these parameters.
2851
2852 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2853 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002854 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002855 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2856 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2857 read-only.]
2858
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002859 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2860 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2861 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2862 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2863
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002864- Protected RAM:
2865 CONFIG_PRAM
2866
2867 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2868 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2869 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2870 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2871 this default value by defining an environment
2872 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2873 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2874 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2875 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2876 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2877 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2878 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2879
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002880 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002881 saveenv
2882
2883 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2884 either, which results in a memory region that will
2885 not be affected by reboots.
2886
2887 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2888 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2889 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2890 following board configurations are known to be
2891 "pRAM-clean":
2892
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002893 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2894 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002895 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002896
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002897- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2898 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2899 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2900 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2901 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2902 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2903 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2904
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002905- Error Recovery:
2906 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2907
2908 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2909 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2910 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002911 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002912 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2913 useful during development since you can try to debug
2914 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2915
2916 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2917
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002918 This variable defines the number of retries for
2919 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2920 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2921 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002922
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002923 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2924
2925 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2926
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002927 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2928
2929 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2930 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2931 try longer timeout such as
2932 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2933
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002934- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002935 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002936
2937 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2938
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002939 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002940
2941 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2942 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2943 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2944
2945 Note:
2946
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002947 In the current implementation, the local variables
2948 space and global environment variables space are
2949 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2950 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2951 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2952 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2953 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002954
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002955 Global environment variables are those you use
2956 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2957 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2958 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002959
2960 To store commands and special characters in a
2961 variable, please use double quotation marks
2962 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2963 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2964 symbols.
2965
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002966- Command Line Editing and History:
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002967 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2968
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002969 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002970 command line input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002971
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002972- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002973 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2974
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002975 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2976 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002977 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002978
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002979 For example, place something like this in your
2980 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002981
2982 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2983 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2984 "myvar2=value2\0"
2985
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002986 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2987 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2988 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2989 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002990 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002991 You better know what you are doing here.
2992
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002993 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2994 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002995 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002996 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002997
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002998 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2999
3000 Define this in order to add variables describing the
3001 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
3002 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
3003
3004 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
3005
3006 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
3007 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
3008 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
3009 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
3010 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
3011
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00003012 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
3013
3014 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
3015 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
3016 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
3017
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00003018 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
3019
3020 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003021 initialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00003022 that so that the environment is not available until
3023 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
3024 this is instead controlled by the value of
3025 /config/load-environment.
3026
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003027- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00003028 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
3029
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003030 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
3031 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
3032 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00003033
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07003034- Serial Flash support
3035 CONFIG_CMD_SF
3036
3037 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
3038 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
3039
3040 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
3041 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
3042 commands.
3043
3044 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
3045 to handle the common case when only a single serial
3046 flash is present on the system.
3047
3048 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
3049 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
3050 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
3051 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
3052
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00003053 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
3054
3055 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
3056 test ('sf test').
3057
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki1dcd6d02013-06-19 15:33:58 +05303058 CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR Ban/Extended Addr Reg
3059
3060 Define this option to use the Bank addr/Extended addr
3061 support on SPI flashes which has size > 16Mbytes.
3062
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05303063 CONFIG_SF_DUAL_FLASH Dual flash memories
3064
3065 Define this option to use dual flash support where two flash
3066 memories can be connected with a given cs line.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003067 Currently Xilinx Zynq qspi supports these type of connections.
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05303068
Heiko Schocher562f8df2014-07-18 06:07:21 +02003069 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_ST_ENABLE_WP_PIN
3070 enable the W#/Vpp signal to disable writing to the status
3071 register on ST MICRON flashes like the N25Q128.
3072 The status register write enable/disable bit, combined with
3073 the W#/VPP signal provides hardware data protection for the
3074 device as follows: When the enable/disable bit is set to 1,
3075 and the W#/VPP signal is driven LOW, the status register
3076 nonvolatile bits become read-only and the WRITE STATUS REGISTER
3077 operation will not execute. The only way to exit this
3078 hardware-protected mode is to drive W#/VPP HIGH.
3079
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003080- SystemACE Support:
3081 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
3082
3083 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
3084 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003085 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003086 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003087
3088 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003089 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003090
3091 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
3092 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
3093
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003094- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
3095 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
3096
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003097 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003098 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003099 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003100 number generator is used.
3101
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003102 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
3103 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
3104 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
3105
3106 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003107 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
3108 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
3109 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
3110 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
3111 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
3112 but sometimes that is not allowed.
3113
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003114- Hashing support:
3115 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
3116
3117 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
3118 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
3119
3120 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
3121
3122 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
3123 size a little.
3124
gaurav rana94e3c8c2015-02-20 12:51:46 +05303125 CONFIG_SHA1 - This option enables support of hashing using SHA1
3126 algorithm. The hash is calculated in software.
3127 CONFIG_SHA256 - This option enables support of hashing using
3128 SHA256 algorithm. The hash is calculated in software.
3129 CONFIG_SHA_HW_ACCEL - This option enables hardware acceleration
3130 for SHA1/SHA256 hashing.
3131 This affects the 'hash' command and also the
3132 hash_lookup_algo() function.
3133 CONFIG_SHA_PROG_HW_ACCEL - This option enables
3134 hardware-acceleration for SHA1/SHA256 progressive hashing.
3135 Data can be streamed in a block at a time and the hashing
3136 is performed in hardware.
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003137
3138 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
3139 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
3140
Robert Winklera11f1872013-07-24 17:57:06 -07003141- Freescale i.MX specific commands:
3142 CONFIG_CMD_HDMIDETECT
3143 This enables 'hdmidet' command which returns true if an
3144 HDMI monitor is detected. This command is i.MX 6 specific.
3145
3146 CONFIG_CMD_BMODE
3147 This enables the 'bmode' (bootmode) command for forcing
3148 a boot from specific media.
3149
3150 This is useful for forcing the ROM's usb downloader to
3151 activate upon a watchdog reset which is nice when iterating
3152 on U-Boot. Using the reset button or running bmode normal
3153 will set it back to normal. This command currently
3154 supports i.MX53 and i.MX6.
3155
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003156- Signing support:
3157 CONFIG_RSA
3158
3159 This enables the RSA algorithm used for FIT image verification
Detlev Zundel8bf2aad2014-01-20 16:21:46 +01003160 in U-Boot. See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more information.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003161
Ruchika Guptac937ff62015-01-23 16:01:54 +05303162 The Modular Exponentiation algorithm in RSA is implemented using
3163 driver model. So CONFIG_DM needs to be enabled by default for this
3164 library to function.
3165
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003166 The signing part is build into mkimage regardless of this
Ruchika Guptac937ff62015-01-23 16:01:54 +05303167 option. The software based modular exponentiation is built into
3168 mkimage irrespective of this option.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003169
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01003170- bootcount support:
3171 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
3172
3173 This enables the bootcounter support, see:
3174 http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
3175
3176 CONFIG_AT91SAM9XE
3177 enable special bootcounter support on at91sam9xe based boards.
3178 CONFIG_BLACKFIN
3179 enable special bootcounter support on blackfin based boards.
3180 CONFIG_SOC_DA8XX
3181 enable special bootcounter support on da850 based boards.
3182 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_RAM
3183 enable support for the bootcounter in RAM
3184 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_I2C
3185 enable support for the bootcounter on an i2c (like RTC) device.
3186 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RTC_ADDR = i2c chip address
3187 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = i2c addr which is used for
3188 the bootcounter.
3189 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ALEN = address len
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003190
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003191- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003192 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
3193
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003194 Defining this option allows to add some board-
3195 specific code (calling a user-provided function
3196 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
3197 the system's boot progress on some display (for
3198 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
3199 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003200
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00003201- Detailed boot stage timing
3202 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
3203 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
3204 of the boot process.
3205
3206 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
3207 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
3208 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
3209 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
3210 the limit, recording will stop.
3211
3212 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
3213 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
3214
3215 Timer summary in microseconds:
3216 Mark Elapsed Stage
3217 0 0 reset
3218 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
3219 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
3220 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
3221 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
3222 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
3223 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
3224 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
3225
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00003226 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
3227 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
3228 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
3229
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00003230 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
3231 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
3232 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
3233 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
3234 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
3235 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
3236 For example:
3237
3238 bootstage {
3239 154 {
3240 name = "board_init_f";
3241 mark = <3575678>;
3242 };
3243 170 {
3244 name = "lcd";
3245 accum = <33482>;
3246 };
3247 };
3248
3249 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
3250
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003251Legacy uImage format:
3252
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003253 Arg Where When
3254 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003255 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003256 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003257 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003258 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003259 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003260 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
3261 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
3262 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003263 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003264 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
3265 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
3266 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
3267 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003268 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003269 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003270
3271 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3272 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
3273 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
3274 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
3275 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
3276 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
3277 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003278 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003279 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
3280 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
3281
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003282 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003283
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003284 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd542004-02-27 00:07:27 +00003285 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
3286 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00003287
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003288 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
3289 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
3290 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
3291 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
3292 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
3293 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3294 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
3295 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
3296 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
3297 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
3298 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3299 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
3300 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3301 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
3302 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
3303 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
3304 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
3305 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
3306 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
3307 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
3308 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
3309 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
3310 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
3311 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
3312 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
3313 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
3314 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3315 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
3316 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
3317 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
3318 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
3319 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
3320 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
3321 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
3322 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
3323 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
3324 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
3325 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
3326 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
3327 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3328 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
3329 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3330 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
3331 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
3332 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
3333 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
3334 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003335
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003336 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003337
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003338 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003339 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
3340 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00003341
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003342 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
3343 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003344 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003345 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
3346 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
3347 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02003348 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
3349 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003350 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003351
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003352FIT uImage format:
3353
3354 Arg Where When
3355 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
3356 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
3357 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
3358 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
3359 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
3360 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01003361 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003362 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
3363 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
3364 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
3365 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
3366 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003367 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
3368 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003369 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
3370 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
3371 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
3372 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
3373 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
3374 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
3375 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
3376 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
3377
3378 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3379 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
3380 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003381 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003382 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
3383 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
3384 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
3385 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
3386 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
3387 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
3388 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
3389 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
3390 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
3391 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
3392 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
3393 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
3394
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003395 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003396 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
3397
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003398 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003399 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
3400
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003401 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003402 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
3403
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003404- legacy image format:
3405 CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3406 enables the legacy image format support in U-Boot.
3407
3408 Default:
3409 enabled if CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is not defined.
3410
3411 CONFIG_DISABLE_IMAGE_LEGACY
3412 disable the legacy image format
3413
3414 This define is introduced, as the legacy image format is
3415 enabled per default for backward compatibility.
3416
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00003417- FIT image support:
3418 CONFIG_FIT
3419 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
3420
3421 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
3422 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
3423 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
3424 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
3425 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
3426 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
3427
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003428 CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE
3429 This option enables signature verification of FIT uImages,
gaurav rana94e3c8c2015-02-20 12:51:46 +05303430 using a hash signed and verified using RSA. If
3431 CONFIG_SHA_PROG_HW_ACCEL is defined, i.e support for progressive
3432 hashing is available using hardware, RSA library will use it.
3433 See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more details.
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003434
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003435 WARNING: When relying on signed FIT images with required
3436 signature check the legacy image format is default
3437 disabled. If a board need legacy image format support
3438 enable this through CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3439
Dirk Eibach9a4f4792014-07-03 09:28:26 +02003440 CONFIG_FIT_DISABLE_SHA256
3441 Supporting SHA256 hashes has quite an impact on binary size.
3442 For constrained systems sha256 hash support can be disabled
3443 with this option.
3444
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003445- Standalone program support:
3446 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
3447
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02003448 This option defines a board specific value for the
3449 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
3450 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003451 settings.
3452
3453- Frame Buffer Address:
3454 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
3455
3456 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00003457 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
3458 when using a graphics controller has separate video
3459 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
3460 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
3461 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
3462 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
3463 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003464
3465 Please see board_init_f function.
3466
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01003467- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
3468 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
3469 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
3470 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
3471
3472 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
3473 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
3474
3475- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
3476 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
3477
3478 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
3479 Needed for mtdparts command support.
3480
3481 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
3482
3483 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
3484 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
3485
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003486- UBI support
3487 CONFIG_CMD_UBI
3488
3489 Adds commands for interacting with MTD partitions formatted
3490 with the UBI flash translation layer
3491
3492 Requires also defining CONFIG_RBTREE
3493
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003494 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3495
3496 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
3497 warnings and errors enabled.
3498
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003499
3500 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
3501 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
3502 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
3503 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
3504 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
3505 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
3506
3507 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
3508 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
3509 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
3510 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
3511 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
3512
3513 default: 4096
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -06003514
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003515 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
3516 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
3517 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
3518 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
3519 flash), this value is ignored.
3520
3521 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
3522 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
3523 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
3524 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
3525 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
3526 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
3527
3528 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
3529 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
3530 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
3531 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
3532 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
3533 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
3534 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
3535 partition.
3536
3537 default: 20
3538
3539 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
3540 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
3541 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
3542 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
3543 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
3544 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
3545 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
3546 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
3547 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
3548 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
3549 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
3550 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
3551
3552 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
3553 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
3554 without a fastmap.
3555 default: 0
3556
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003557- UBIFS support
3558 CONFIG_CMD_UBIFS
3559
3560 Adds commands for interacting with UBI volumes formatted as
3561 UBIFS. UBIFS is read-only in u-boot.
3562
3563 Requires UBI support as well as CONFIG_LZO
3564
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003565 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3566
3567 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
3568 warnings and errors enabled.
3569
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003570- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003571 CONFIG_SPL
3572 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003573
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003574 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
3575 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
3576
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003577 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
3578 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
3579 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
3580 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003581 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003582 must not be both defined at the same time.
3583
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003584 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003585 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
3586 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
3587 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
3588 not exceed it.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003589
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003590 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
3591 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003592
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003593 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
3594 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
3595 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
3596
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003597 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
3598 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
3599
3600 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003601 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
3602 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
3603 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003604 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003605 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003606
3607 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
3608 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
3609
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)8c80eb32015-03-31 11:40:50 +02003610 CONFIG_SPL_PANIC_ON_RAW_IMAGE
3611 When defined, SPL will panic() if the image it has
3612 loaded does not have a signature.
3613 Defining this is useful when code which loads images
3614 in SPL cannot guarantee that absolutely all read errors
3615 will be caught.
3616 An example is the LPC32XX MLC NAND driver, which will
3617 consider that a completely unreadable NAND block is bad,
3618 and thus should be skipped silently.
3619
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003620 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
3621 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
3622 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
3623 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
3624
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003625 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
3626 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
3627
3628 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
3629 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003630
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07003631 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
3632 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
3633 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
3634 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
3635
Tom Rini9607faf2014-03-28 12:03:39 -04003636 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
3637 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
3638 See also: doc/README.falcon
3639
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07003640 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
3641 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
3642 about the running system.
3643
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05003644 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
3645 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
3646
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003647 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
3648 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003649
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003650 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
3651 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003652
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003653 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
3654 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003655
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003656 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
3657 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003658
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003659 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
3660 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003661
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003662 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
3663 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
Paul Kocialkowskie2ccdf82014-11-08 23:14:55 +01003664 Address and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003665 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
3666
Paul Kocialkowskib97300b2014-11-08 23:14:56 +01003667 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_PARTITION
3668 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
3669 used in raw mode
3670
Peter Korsgaard2b75b0a2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00003671 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
3672 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
3673 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
3674
3675 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
3676 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
3677 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
3678 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
3679 (for falcon mode)
3680
Paul Kocialkowskie2ccdf82014-11-08 23:14:55 +01003681 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_FS_BOOT_PARTITION
3682 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
3683 used in fs mode
3684
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003685 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
3686 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
3687
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003688 CONFIG_SPL_EXT_SUPPORT
3689 Support for EXT filesystem in SPL binary
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003690
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003691 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
3692 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from filesystem
3693
3694 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003695 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003696 from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003697
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003698 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003699 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003700 when reading from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003701
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00003702 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
3703 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
3704 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
3705 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
3706 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
3707
Prabhakar Kushwaha651fcf62014-04-08 19:12:31 +05303708 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
3709 Avoid SPL relocation
3710
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05003711 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
3712 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
3713 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
3714
3715 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
3716 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
3717
3718 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
3719 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
3720
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003721 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003722 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
3723 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003724
Tom Rini6dd3b562014-03-28 12:03:36 -04003725 CONFIG_SPL_MTD_SUPPORT
3726 Support for the MTD subsystem within SPL. Useful for
3727 environment on NAND support within SPL.
3728
Heiko Schocher0c3117b2014-10-31 08:31:00 +01003729 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_RAW_ONLY
3730 Support to boot only raw u-boot.bin images. Use this only
3731 if you need to save space.
3732
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003733 CONFIG_SPL_MPC8XXX_INIT_DDR_SUPPORT
3734 Set for the SPL on PPC mpc8xxx targets, support for
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -07003735 drivers/ddr/fsl/libddr.o in SPL binary.
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003736
Ying Zhang7c8eea52013-08-16 15:16:12 +08003737 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
3738 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
3739 SPL binary.
3740
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003741 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
3742 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
3743 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
3744 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
3745 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
3746 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003747 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003748
Prabhakar Kushwahafbe76ae2013-12-11 12:42:11 +05303749 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
3750 Add support NAND boot
3751
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003752 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003753 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
3754
3755 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
3756 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
3757
3758 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
3759 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003760
3761 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003762 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003763
3764 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
3765 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003766 data. This is used, for example, on davinci platforms.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003767
3768 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
3769 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
3770 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
3771
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003772 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
3773 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003774
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003775 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
3776 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003777
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003778 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
3779 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003780
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02003781 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
3782 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
3783
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003784 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
3785 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003786
Ying Zhangba1bee42013-05-20 14:07:25 +08003787 CONFIG_SPL_ENV_SUPPORT
3788 Support for the environment operating in SPL binary
3789
3790 CONFIG_SPL_NET_SUPPORT
3791 Support for the net/libnet.o in SPL binary.
3792 It conflicts with SPL env from storage medium specified by
3793 CONFIG_ENV_IS_xxx but CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
3794
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003795 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeau6113d3f2013-04-11 09:35:49 +00003796 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
3797 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
3798 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3799 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3800 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003801
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05003802 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
3803 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
3804 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
3805 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
3806
Simon Glass87ebee32013-05-08 08:05:59 +00003807 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
3808 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
3809 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
3810 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
3811 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
3812
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003813- TPL framework
3814 CONFIG_TPL
3815 Enable building of TPL globally.
3816
3817 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
3818 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
3819 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02003820 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3821 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3822 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003823
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003824Modem Support:
3825--------------
3826
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02003827[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003828
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003829- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003830 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
3831
3832- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
3833 CONFIG_HWFLOW
3834
3835- Modem debug support:
3836 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
3837
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003838 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
3839 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003840
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003841- Interrupt support (PPC):
3842
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003843 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
3844 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003845 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003846 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003847 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003848 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003849 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003850 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
3851 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
3852 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003853
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003854- General:
3855
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003856 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
3857 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
3858 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003859 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003860 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
3861 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
3862 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003863
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003864 If there are no modem init strings in the
3865 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
3866 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003867 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003868
3869 See also: doc/README.Modem
3870
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003871Board initialization settings:
3872------------------------------
3873
3874During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3875to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3876before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3877following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3878architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3879typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3880
3881- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3882- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3883- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3884- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003885
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003886Configuration Settings:
3887-----------------------
3888
York Sun4d1fd7f2014-02-26 17:03:19 -08003889- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
3890 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
3891
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003892- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003893 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3894
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003895- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3896 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3897
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003898- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003899 prompt for user input.
3900
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003901- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003902
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003903- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003904
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003905- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003906
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003907- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003908 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3909 booted
3910
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003911- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003912 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3913
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003914- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003915 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003916
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003917- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003918 If the board specific function
3919 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3920 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003921 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3922
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003923- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003924 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003925
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003926- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003927 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3928
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003929- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003930 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3931 simple memory test.
3932
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003933- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003934 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003935
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003936- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003937 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3938 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3939
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003940- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3941 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003942 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003943 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003944 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3945 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3946 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003947 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003948 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003949 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003950
3951 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3952 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3953 be touched.
3954
3955 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3956 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3957 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3958 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3959 problems.
3960
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003961- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003962 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3963
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003964- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003965 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3966
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003967- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003968 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3969 Cogent motherboard)
3970
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003971- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003972 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3973
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003974- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003975 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3976 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003977 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003978 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003979
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003980- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003981 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3982 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3983 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3984 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003985
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003986- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003987 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3988
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003989- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
3990 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
3991 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
3992 will become available before relocation. The address is just
3993 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
3994 space.
3995
3996 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
3997 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
3998 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003999 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotten) when
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06004000 U-Boot relocates itself.
4001
Simon Glasse7b14e92014-09-15 06:33:18 -06004002 Pre-relocation malloc() is only supported on ARM and sandbox
Simon Glass29afe9e2014-07-10 22:23:31 -06004003 at present but is fairly easy to enable for other archs.
4004
Simon Glass38687ae2014-11-10 17:16:54 -07004005- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE
4006 Provides a simple and small malloc() and calloc() for those
4007 boards which do not use the full malloc in SPL (which is
4008 enabled with CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START).
4009
Thierry Reding1dfdd9b2014-12-09 22:25:22 -07004010- CONFIG_SYS_NONCACHED_MEMORY:
4011 Size of non-cached memory area. This area of memory will be
4012 typically located right below the malloc() area and mapped
4013 uncached in the MMU. This is useful for drivers that would
4014 otherwise require a lot of explicit cache maintenance. For
4015 some drivers it's also impossible to properly maintain the
4016 cache. For example if the regions that need to be flushed
4017 are not a multiple of the cache-line size, *and* padding
4018 cannot be allocated between the regions to align them (i.e.
4019 if the HW requires a contiguous array of regions, and the
4020 size of each region is not cache-aligned), then a flush of
4021 one region may result in overwriting data that hardware has
4022 written to another region in the same cache-line. This can
4023 happen for example in network drivers where descriptors for
4024 buffers are typically smaller than the CPU cache-line (e.g.
4025 16 bytes vs. 32 or 64 bytes).
4026
4027 Non-cached memory is only supported on 32-bit ARM at present.
4028
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004029- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01004030 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
4031 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004032 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01004033 to adjust this setting to your needs.
4034
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004035- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004036 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
4037 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004038 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
4039 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04004040 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004041 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004042 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004043 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
4044 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
4045 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004046
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06004047- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
4048 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
4049 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
4050 is enabled.
4051
4052- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
4053 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
4054 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
4055
4056- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
4057 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
4058 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
4059
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004060- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004061 Max number of Flash memory banks
4062
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004063- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004064 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
4065
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004066- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004067 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
4068
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004069- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004070 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
4071
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004072- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004073 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
4074
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004075- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004076 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
4077
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004078- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004079 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
4080 instead of U-Boot software protection.
4081
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004082- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004083
4084 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
4085 without this option such a download has to be
4086 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
4087 copy from RAM to flash.
4088
4089 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
4090 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004091 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
4092 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004093 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
4094
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004095- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004096 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00004097 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
4098
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02004099- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00004100 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
4101 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004102
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01004103- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
4104 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
4105 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
4106 to the MTD layer.
4107
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004108- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02004109 Use buffered writes to flash.
4110
4111- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
4112 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
4113 write commands.
4114
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004115- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01004116 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
4117 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
4118 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
4119 optionally available.
4120
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05004121- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
4122 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
4123 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
4124 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
4125
Stefan Roese352ef3f2013-04-04 15:53:14 +02004126- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
4127 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
4128 against the source after the write operation. An error message
4129 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
4130 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
4131 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
4132 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
4133 this option if you really know what you are doing.
4134
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004135- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004136 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
4137 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00004138 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
4139 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004140 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00004141 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
4142
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02004143- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
4144
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02004145 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
4146 internally to store the environment settings. The default
4147 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
4148 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
4149 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02004150
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004151- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4152- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04004153 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004154 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
4155 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
4156 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
4157
4158 The format of the list is:
4159 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004160 access_attribute = [a|r|o|c]
4161 attributes = type_attribute[access_attribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004162 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
4163 list = entry[,list]
4164
4165 The type attributes are:
4166 s - String (default)
4167 d - Decimal
4168 x - Hexadecimal
4169 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
4170 i - IP address
4171 m - MAC address
4172
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004173 The access attributes are:
4174 a - Any (default)
4175 r - Read-only
4176 o - Write-once
4177 c - Change-default
4178
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004179 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4180 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004181 environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004182
4183 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
4184 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
4185 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
4186 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
4187 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
4188 ".flags" variable.
4189
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004190- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
4191 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
4192 access flags.
4193
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004194- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
4195 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
4196 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
4197 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
4198 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
4199 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
Masahiro Yamada0a12e682015-03-19 19:42:51 +09004200 must support it (i.e. must select HAVE_GENERIC_BOARD in arch/Kconfig).
4201 If you find problems enabling this option on your board please report
4202 the problem and send patches!
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004203
Lokesh Vutla0b1b60c2013-04-17 20:49:40 +00004204- CONFIG_OMAP_PLATFORM_RESET_TIME_MAX_USEC (OMAP only)
4205 This is set by OMAP boards for the max time that reset should
4206 be asserted. See doc/README.omap-reset-time for details on how
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004207 the value can be calculated on a given board.
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00004208
Gabe Black0d296cc2014-10-15 04:38:30 -06004209- CONFIG_USE_STDINT
4210 If stdint.h is available with your toolchain you can define this
4211 option to enable it. You can provide option 'USE_STDINT=1' when
4212 building U-Boot to enable this.
4213
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004214The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
4215of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
4216following configurations:
4217
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00004218- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
4219
4220 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
4221 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
4222
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004223- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004224
4225 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
4226
4227 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
4228 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
4229 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
4230 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
4231 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
4232 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
4233 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
4234 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
4235 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
4236 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
4237 between U-Boot and the environment.
4238
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004239 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004240
4241 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
4242 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
4243 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
4244 for this sector is given here.
4245
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004246 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004247
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004248 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004249
4250 This is just another way to specify the start address of
4251 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004252 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004253
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004254 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004255
4256 Size of the sector containing the environment.
4257
4258
4259 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
4260 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
4261 the environment.
4262
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004263 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004264
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004265 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004266 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004267 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
4268 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
4269
4270 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
4271 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
4272 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
4273 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
4274 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
4275 updating the environment in flash makes it always
4276 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
4277 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
4278 RAM, your target system will be dead.
4279
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004280 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
4281 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004282
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004283 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004284 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00004285 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004286 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004287
4288BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
4289source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
4290accordingly!
4291
4292
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02004293- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004294
4295 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
4296 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
4297 environment.
4298
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004299 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4300 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004301
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004302 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004303 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
4304 can just be read and written to, without any special
4305 provision.
4306
4307BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004308in U-Boot initialization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004309console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004310U-Boot will hang.
4311
4312Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
4313environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
4314keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
4315to save the current settings.
4316
4317
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02004318- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004319
4320 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
4321 device and a driver for it.
4322
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004323 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4324 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004325
4326 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4327 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
4328
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004329 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004330 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
4331 The default address is zero.
4332
Christian Gmeiner189d2572015-02-11 15:19:31 +01004333 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_BUS:
4334 If defined, specified the i2c bus of the EEPROM device.
4335
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004336 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004337 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
4338 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
4339 would require six bits.
4340
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004341 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004342 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00004343 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004344
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004345 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004346 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
4347 that this is NOT the chip address length!
4348
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004349 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004350 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
4351 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
4352 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
4353 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
4354 byte chips.
4355
4356 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
4357 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
4358 in the chip address.
4359
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004360 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004361 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
4362
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004363 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
4364 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
4365 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
4366
4367 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
4368 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
4369 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
4370 EEPROM. For example:
4371
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01004372 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS 1
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004373
4374 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
4375 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004376
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004377- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004378
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00004379 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004380 want to use for the environment.
4381
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004382 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4383 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4384 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004385
4386 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
4387 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
4388 at the specified address.
4389
Wu, Joshbd83b592014-07-01 19:30:13 +08004390- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH:
4391
4392 Define this if you have a SPI Flash memory device which you
4393 want to use for the environment.
4394
4395 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4396 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4397
4398 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4399 environment area within the SPI Flash. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4400 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4401
4402 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
4403
4404 Define the SPI flash's sector size.
4405
4406 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4407
4408 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
4409 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4410 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
4411 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
4412 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4413
4414 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_BUS (optional):
4415 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_CS (optional):
4416
4417 Define the SPI bus and chip select. If not defined they will be 0.
4418
4419 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ (optional):
4420
4421 Define the SPI max work clock. If not defined then use 1MHz.
4422
4423 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE (optional):
4424
4425 Define the SPI work mode. If not defined then use SPI_MODE_3.
4426
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004427- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
4428
4429 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
4430 want to use for the local device's environment.
4431
4432 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4433 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4434
4435 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
4436 environment area within the remote memory space. The
4437 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004438 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004439
4440BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
4441"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004442environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
4443but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004444
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004445- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004446
4447 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
4448 for the environment.
4449
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004450 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4451 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004452
4453 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004454 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4455 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004456
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004457 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004458
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004459 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004460 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4461 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004462 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004463 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004464
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004465 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
4466
4467 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
4468 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
4469 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
4470 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
4471 the range to be avoided.
4472
4473 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
4474
4475 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
4476 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
4477 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
4478 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
4479 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004480
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02004481- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
4482
4483 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
4484 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
4485 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4486
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004487- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_UBI:
4488
4489 Define this if you have an UBI volume that you want to use for the
4490 environment. This has the benefit of wear-leveling the environment
4491 accesses, which is important on NAND.
4492
4493 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_PART:
4494
4495 Define this to a string that is the mtd partition containing the UBI.
4496
4497 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME:
4498
4499 Define this to the name of the volume that you want to store the
4500 environment in.
4501
Joe Hershberger785881f2013-04-08 10:32:52 +00004502 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME_REDUND:
4503
4504 Define this to the name of another volume to store a second copy of
4505 the environment in. This will enable redundant environments in UBI.
4506 It is assumed that both volumes are in the same MTD partition.
4507
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004508 - CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
4509 - CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
4510
4511 You will probably want to define these to avoid a really noisy system
4512 when storing the env in UBI.
4513
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004514- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FAT:
4515 Define this if you want to use the FAT file system for the environment.
4516
4517 - FAT_ENV_INTERFACE:
4518
4519 Define this to a string that is the name of the block device.
4520
4521 - FAT_ENV_DEV_AND_PART:
4522
4523 Define this to a string to specify the partition of the device. It can
4524 be as following:
4525
4526 "D:P", "D:0", "D", "D:" or "D:auto" (D, P are integers. And P >= 1)
4527 - "D:P": device D partition P. Error occurs if device D has no
4528 partition table.
4529 - "D:0": device D.
4530 - "D" or "D:": device D partition 1 if device D has partition
4531 table, or the whole device D if has no partition
4532 table.
4533 - "D:auto": first partition in device D with bootable flag set.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004534 If none, first valid partition in device D. If no
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004535 partition table then means device D.
4536
4537 - FAT_ENV_FILE:
4538
4539 It's a string of the FAT file name. This file use to store the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004540 environment.
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004541
4542 - CONFIG_FAT_WRITE:
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004543 This should be defined. Otherwise it cannot save the environment file.
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004544
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004545- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC:
4546
4547 Define this if you have an MMC device which you want to use for the
4548 environment.
4549
4550 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV:
4551
4552 Specifies which MMC device the environment is stored in.
4553
4554 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART (optional):
4555
4556 Specifies which MMC partition the environment is stored in. If not
4557 set, defaults to partition 0, the user area. Common values might be
4558 1 (first MMC boot partition), 2 (second MMC boot partition).
4559
4560 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4561 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4562
4563 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
4564 area within the specified MMC device.
4565
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004566 If offset is positive (the usual case), it is treated as relative to
4567 the start of the MMC partition. If offset is negative, it is treated
4568 as relative to the end of the MMC partition. This can be useful if
4569 your board may be fitted with different MMC devices, which have
4570 different sizes for the MMC partitions, and you always want the
4571 environment placed at the very end of the partition, to leave the
4572 maximum possible space before it, to store other data.
4573
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004574 These two values are in units of bytes, but must be aligned to an
4575 MMC sector boundary.
4576
4577 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4578
4579 Specifies a second storage area, of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE size, used to
4580 hold a redundant copy of the environment data. This provides a
4581 valid backup copy in case the other copy is corrupted, e.g. due
4582 to a power failure during a "saveenv" operation.
4583
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004584 This value may also be positive or negative; this is handled in the
4585 same way as CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET.
4586
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004587 This value is also in units of bytes, but must also be aligned to
4588 an MMC sector boundary.
4589
4590 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND (optional):
4591
4592 This value need not be set, even when CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is
4593 set. If this value is set, it must be set to the same value as
4594 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4595
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004596- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597
4598 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
4599 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
4600 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
4601 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
4602 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
4603 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
4604 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
4605
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07004606Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004607has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02004608created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004609until then to read environment variables.
4610
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004611The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
4612is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
4613with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
4614necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
4615"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
4616have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004617
4618Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
4619the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004620use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004621
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004622- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004623 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004624
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004625 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004626 also needs to be defined.
4627
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004628- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004629 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004630
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08004631- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
4632 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
4633 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
4634 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
4635 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
4636 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
4637
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00004638- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
4639 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
4640 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
4641 to do this.
4642
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00004643- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
4644 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
4645 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
4646 present.
4647
Sascha Silbefeb85802013-08-11 16:40:43 +02004648- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
4649 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
4650 build system checks that the actual size does not
4651 exceed it.
4652
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004653Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00004654---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004655
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004656- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004657 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
4658
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004659- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004660 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00004661
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004662 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
4663 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
4664 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004665
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004666- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
4667 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
4668 PowerPC SOCs.
4669
4670- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
4671 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
4672 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
4673
4674 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
4675 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
4676
4677- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
4678 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
4679 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004680 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004681 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
4682 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
4683 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
4684
4685 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
4686 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
4687
4688- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02004689 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
4690 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004691 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4692 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4693
4694- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
4695 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
4696 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4697 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4698
4699- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
4700 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
4701 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
4702
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004703- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004704 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004705
4706 the default drive number (default value 0)
4707
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004708 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004709
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004710 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004711 (default value 1)
4712
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004713 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004714
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004715 defines the offset of register from address. It
4716 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004717 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004718
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004719 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
4720 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004721 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004722
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004723 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004724 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
4725 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004726 source code. It is used to make hardware-dependent
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004727 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004728
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004729- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
4730 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
4731 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
4732 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
4733 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
4734 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004735 is required.
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004736
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004737- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004738 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00004739 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004740
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004741- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004742
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00004743 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004744 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
4745 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
4746 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
4747 will become available only after programming the
4748 memory controller and running certain initialization
4749 sequences.
4750
4751 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
4752 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
4753 - MPC824X: data cache
4754 - PPC4xx: data cache
4755
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004756- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004757
4758 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004759 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
4760 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004761 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02004762 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004763 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
4764 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
4765 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004766
4767 Note:
4768 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
4769 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004770 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004771 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
4772 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
4773
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004774- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004775
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004776- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004777
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004778- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004779
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004780- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004781
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004782- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004783
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004784- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004785
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004786- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004787 SDRAM timing
4788
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004789- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004790 periodic timer for refresh
4791
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004792- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004793
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004794- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
4795 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
4796 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
4797 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004798 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
4799
4800- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004801 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
4802 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004803 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
4804
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004805- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
4806 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004807 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
4808 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
4809
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004810- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004811 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4812 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
4813
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004814- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01004815 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4816 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
4817
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004818- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004819 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4820 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
4821
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004822- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004823 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
4824 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
4825 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
4826
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004827- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004828 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
4829 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
4830 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
4831 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00004832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004833- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4834 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
4835 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
4836 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4837 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
4838 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
4839 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
4840 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004841 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00004842
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01004843- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
4844 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
4845 required.
4846
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004847- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004848 Only scan through and get the devices on the buses.
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004849 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
4850 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
4851 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
4852 by coreboot or similar.
4853
Gabor Juhos842033e2013-05-30 07:06:12 +00004854- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
4855 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
4856
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004857- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
4858 Chip has SRIO or not
4859
4860- CONFIG_SRIO1:
4861 Board has SRIO 1 port available
4862
4863- CONFIG_SRIO2:
4864 Board has SRIO 2 port available
4865
Liu Gangc8b28152013-05-07 16:30:46 +08004866- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
4867 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
4868
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004869- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
4870 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4871
4872- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
4873 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4874
4875- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
4876 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4877
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004878- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
4879 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
4880 a 16 bit bus.
4881 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004882 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004883 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004884 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04004885
4886- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
4887 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
4888 a default value will be used.
4889
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004890- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004891 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
4892 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
4893
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004894 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
4895 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
4896
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004897- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004898 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
4899 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
4900 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004901
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08004902- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
4903 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
4904 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
4905 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
4906 header files or board specific files.
4907
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07004908- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
4909 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
4910
York Sune32d59a2015-01-06 13:18:55 -08004911- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_SYNC_REFRESH
4912 Enable sync of refresh for multiple controllers.
4913
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004914- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004915 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
4916 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06004917
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004918- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
4919 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
4920
4921- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
4922 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00004923 to the given FEC; i. e.
4924 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004925 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
4926
4927 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
4928
4929- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
4930 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
4931 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
4932
4933- CONFIG_RMII
4934 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
4935 Note that this is a global option, we can't
4936 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
4937
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004938- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
4939 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
4940 The syntax is:
4941
4942 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
4943
4944 Where address/count indicate a memory area
4945 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
4946 area should have.
4947
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004948- CONFIG_LOOPW
4949 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004950 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004951
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004952- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
4953 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
4954 "md/mw" commands.
4955 Examples:
4956
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004957 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004958 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
4959
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004960 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004961 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
4962
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004963 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004964 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004965
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004966- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004967 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004968 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
4969 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
4970 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004971
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004972 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
4973 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
4974 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
4975 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004976
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00004977- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02004978 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4979 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
4980 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00004981
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08004982- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
4983 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4984 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
4985 It is loaded by the SPL.
4986
Ying Zhang5df572f2013-05-20 14:07:23 +08004987- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
4988 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
4989 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
4990 previous 4k of the .text section.
4991
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00004992- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
4993 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
4994 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
4995 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
4996 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
4997 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
4998 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
4999 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
5000
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00005001- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
5002 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
5003 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
5004 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
5005 conditions but may increase the binary size.
5006
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00005007- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
5008 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
5009 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00005010
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00005011- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
5012 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
5013
5014 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00005015
Heiko Schocher16678eb2013-11-04 14:05:00 +01005016- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
5017 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
5018
Karicheri, Muralidharan999d7d32014-04-04 13:16:50 -04005019- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
5020 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
5021 driver that uses this:
5022 drivers/mtd/nand/davinci_nand.c
5023
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06005024Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
5025-----------------------------------
5026
5027The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
5028loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
5029This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
5030are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
5031within that device.
5032
Zhao Qiangdcf1d772014-03-21 16:21:44 +08005033- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
5034 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
5035 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
5036 is also specified.
5037
5038- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
5039 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06005040 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
5041 is also specified.
5042
5043- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
5044 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
5045 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
5046 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
5047 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
5048
5049- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
5050 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
5051 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
5052 virtual address in NOR flash.
5053
5054- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
5055 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
5056 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
5057
5058- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
5059 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
5060 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
5061
5062- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
5063 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
5064 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
5065
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00005066- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
5067 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
5068 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00005069 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
5070 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
5071 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06005072
J. German Riverab940ca62014-06-23 15:15:55 -07005073Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
5074---------------------------------------------------------
5075The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
5076"firmware".
5077This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
5078are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
5079within that device.
5080
5081- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
5082 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
5083
5084- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR
5085 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
5086 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_xxx macro
5087 is also specified.
5088
5089- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_LENGTH
5090 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
5091 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
5092 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
5093 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
5094
5095- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_NOR
5096 Specifies that MC firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
5097 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR is the
5098 virtual address in NOR flash.
5099
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005100Building the Software:
5101======================
5102
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005103Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
5104and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
5105all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
5106(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
5107recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
5108which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005109
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005110If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
5111have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
5112you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
5113Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
5114necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005115
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005116 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
5117 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005118
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05005119Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
5120 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
5121 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
5122 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
5123
5124 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
5125
5126 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
5127 be executed on computers running Windows.
5128
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005129U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
5130sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005131is done by typing:
5132
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005133 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005134
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005135where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005136rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00005137
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005138Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
5139 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
5140 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
5141 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005142 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005143
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005144 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005145 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005146
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005147 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005148 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005149
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005150 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005151
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005152
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005153Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
5154images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005155
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005156- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
5157- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
5158- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005159
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005160By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
5161in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
5162this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
5163
51641. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
5165
5166 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005167 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005168 make O=/tmp/build all
5169
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +020051702. Set environment variable KBUILD_OUTPUT to point to the desired location:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005171
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02005172 export KBUILD_OUTPUT=/tmp/build
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005173 make distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005174 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005175 make all
5176
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02005177Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the KBUILD_OUTPUT environment
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005178variable.
5179
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005180
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005181Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
5182for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
5183native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005184
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005185
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005186If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
5187to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
5188steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005189
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000051901. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005191 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
5192 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000051932. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
5194 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
5195 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
51963. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
5197 your board
51983. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
5199 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +020052004. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000052015. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
5202 to be installed on your target system.
52036. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
5204 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005205
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005206
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005207Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
5208==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005209
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005210If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
5211or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005212provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
5213the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005214official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005215
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005216But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
5217cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005218the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
5219just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005220for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
5221select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
5222environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
5223you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005224
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005225 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005226
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005227or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005228
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005229 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005230
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005231When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
5232U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
5233setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
5234built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
5235<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
5236location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
5237variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005238
5239 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5240 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
5241 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
5242
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005243With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
5244log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
5245during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005246
5247
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005248See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005249
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005250
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005251Monitor Commands - Overview:
5252============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005254go - start application at address 'addr'
5255run - run commands in an environment variable
5256bootm - boot application image from memory
5257bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005258bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005259tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
5260 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
5261 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00005262tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005263rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
5264diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
5265loads - load S-Record file over serial line
5266loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
5267md - memory display
5268mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
5269nm - memory modify (constant address)
5270mw - memory write (fill)
5271cp - memory copy
5272cmp - memory compare
5273crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05005274i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005275sspi - SPI utility commands
5276base - print or set address offset
5277printenv- print environment variables
5278setenv - set environment variables
5279saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
5280protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
5281erase - erase FLASH memory
5282flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00005283nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005284bdinfo - print Board Info structure
5285iminfo - print header information for application image
5286coninfo - print console devices and informations
5287ide - IDE sub-system
5288loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00005289loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005290mtest - simple RAM test
5291icache - enable or disable instruction cache
5292dcache - enable or disable data cache
5293reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
5294echo - echo args to console
5295version - print monitor version
5296help - print online help
5297? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005298
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005299
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005300Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
5301========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005302
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005303TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005304
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005305For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005306
5307
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005308Environment Variables:
5309======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005310
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005311U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
5312can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005313
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005314Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
5315"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
5316without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
5317environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
5318working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
5319environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005320
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005321Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
5322
5323List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005324
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005325 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005326
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005327 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005328
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005329 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005330
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005331 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005332
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005333 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005334
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005335 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5336 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5337 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
5338 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
5339 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
5340 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005341 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
5342 bootm_mapsize.
5343
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005344 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005345 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
5346 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
5347 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
5348 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
5349 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
5350 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005351
5352 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5353 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5354 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
5355 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
5356 environment variable.
5357
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02005358 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
5359 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
5360 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
5361
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005362 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
5363 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
5364 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
5365 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005366
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005367 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
5368 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
5369 be automatically started (by internally calling
5370 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005371
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005372 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
5373 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
5374 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
5375 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
5376 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005377
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005378 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
5379 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00005380 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
5381 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
5382 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
5383 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
5384 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
5385 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
5386 access it during the boot procedure.
5387
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005388 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
5389 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
5390 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
5391 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
5392 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
5393 must be accessible by the kernel.
5394
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00005395 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
5396 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
5397 defined.
5398
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00005399 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
5400 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
5401 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
5402 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
5403 it must be saved and board must be reset.
5404
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005405 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
5406 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
5407 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
5408 is usually what you want since it allows for
5409 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
5410 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005411 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005412 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
5413 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
5414 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
5415 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005416
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005417 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
5418 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
5419 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
5420 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
5421 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
5422 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005423
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005424 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005425
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005426 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
5427 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
5428 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
5429 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
5430 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
5431 boot time on your system, but requires that this
5432 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00005433
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005434 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005435
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005436 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
5437 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005438
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005439 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005441 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00005442
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005443 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005444
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005445 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005446
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005447 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005448
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005449 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005450
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005451 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
5452 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005453
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02005454 => setenv ethact FEC
5455 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
5456 => setenv ethact SCC
5457 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005458
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01005459 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
5460 available network interfaces.
5461 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
5462
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005463 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005464 either succeed or fail without retrying.
5465 When set to "once" the network operation will
5466 fail when all the available network interfaces
5467 are tried once without success.
5468 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
5469 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005470
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01005471 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01005472
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005473 silent_linux - If set then Linux will be told to boot silently, by
Simon Glass8d51aac2013-07-16 20:10:00 -07005474 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
5475 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
5476 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
5477 is silent.
5478
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005479 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02005480 UDP source port.
5481
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005482 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
5483 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
5484
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005485 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
5486 we use the TFTP server's default block size
5487
5488 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
5489 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
5490 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
5491 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
5492 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
5493 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
5494 with unreliable TFTP servers.
5495
5496 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005497 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005498 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005499
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005500The following image location variables contain the location of images
5501used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
5502not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
5503variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
5504server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
5505loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
5506flash or offset in NAND flash.
5507
5508*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
5509boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
5510boards use these variables for other purposes.
5511
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005512Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
5513----- --------- ----------- --------------
5514u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
5515Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
5516device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
5517ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005518
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005519The following environment variables may be used and automatically
5520updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
5521depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005522
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005523 bootfile - see above
5524 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
5525 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
5526 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
5527 hostname - Target hostname
5528 ipaddr - see above
5529 netmask - Subnet Mask
5530 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
5531 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005532
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005533
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005534There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005535
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005536 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
5537 as type string and/or serial number
5538 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005539
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005540These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
5541the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
5542once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005543
5544
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005545Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005546
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005547 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
5548 with the "version" command. This variable is
5549 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005550
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005551
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005552Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
5553only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005554
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005555
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005556Callback functions for environment variables:
5557---------------------------------------------
5558
5559For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005560when their values are changed. This functionality allows functions to
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005561be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
5562deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
5563effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
5564
5565The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
5566U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
5567
5568These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
5569static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
5570in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
5571associations. The list must be in the following format:
5572
5573 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
5574 list = entry[,list]
5575
5576If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
5577Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
5578
5579Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
5580with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
5581override any association in the static list. You can define
5582CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005583".callbacks" environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005584
5585
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005586Command Line Parsing:
5587=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005588
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005589There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
5590the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005591
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005592Old, simple command line parser:
5593--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005594
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005595- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
5596- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005597- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005598- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
5599 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005600 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005601- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
5602 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005603
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005604Hush shell:
5605-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005606
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005607- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
5608 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
5609 until...do...done, ...
5610- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
5611 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
5612 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
5613 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005614
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005615General rules:
5616--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005617
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005618(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
5619 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
5620 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
5621 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005622
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005623(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005624 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005625 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
5626 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005627
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005628Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
5629=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005630
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005631Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005632such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
5633"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005634
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005635Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
5636MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
5637"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005638
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005639If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
5640in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
5641ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
5642variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005643
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005644o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
5645 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005646
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005647o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
5648 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
5649 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005650
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005651o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
5652 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005653
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005654o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
5655 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
5656 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005657
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005658o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
5659 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005660
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005661If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005662will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005663may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
5664The naming convention is as follows:
5665"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005666
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005667Image Formats:
5668==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005669
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01005670U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
5671images in two formats:
5672
5673New uImage format (FIT)
5674-----------------------
5675
5676Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
5677to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
5678components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
5679SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
5680
5681
5682Old uImage format
5683-----------------
5684
5685Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
5686preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
5687details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005688
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005689* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
5690 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05005691 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
5692 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
5693 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02005694* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005695 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
5696 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005697* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
5698* Load Address
5699* Entry Point
5700* Image Name
5701* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005702
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005703The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
5704and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
5705CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005706
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005707
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005708Linux Support:
5709==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005710
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005711Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
5712easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
5713U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005714
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005715U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
5716special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
5717"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
5718instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
5719serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005720
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005721- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
5722 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
5723 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005724
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005725- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
5726 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005727
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005728- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
5729 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
5730 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
5731 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
5732 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
5733 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005734
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005735
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005736Linux HOWTO:
5737============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005738
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005739Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
5740---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005741
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005742U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
5743configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
5744(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
5745Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005746
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005747But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005748
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005749Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
5750include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02005751Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
5752and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005753as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005754
Simon Glass2eb31b12014-06-11 23:29:46 -06005755Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
5756If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
5757is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
5758doc/driver-model.
5759
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005760
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005761Configuring the Linux kernel:
5762-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005763
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005764No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
5765device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005766
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005767
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005768Building a Linux Image:
5769-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005770
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005771With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
5772not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
5773"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
5774U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
5775which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
5776100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005777
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005778Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005779
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005780 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005781 make oldconfig
5782 make dep
5783 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005784
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005785The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
5786encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
5787CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005788
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005789* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005790
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005791* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005792
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005793 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
5794 -R .note -R .comment \
5795 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005796
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005797* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005798
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005799 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005800
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005801* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005802
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005803 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
5804 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
5805 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005806
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005807
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005808The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
5809with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
5810combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
5811byte header containing information about target architecture,
5812operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
5813stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005814
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005815"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
5816print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005817
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005818In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
5819contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
5820checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005821
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005822 tools/mkimage -l image
5823 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005824
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005825The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
5826from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005827
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005828 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
5829 -n name -d data_file image
5830 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
5831 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
5832 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5833 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
5834 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
5835 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
5836 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
5837 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005838
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00005839Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
5840address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
5841kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005842
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005843- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
5844- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005845
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005846So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005847
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005848 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5849 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005850 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005851 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
5852 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5853 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5854 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5855 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5856 Load Address: 0x00000000
5857 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005858
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005859To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005860
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005861 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
5862 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5863 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5864 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5865 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5866 Load Address: 0x00000000
5867 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005868
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005869NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
5870speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
5871needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
5872need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005873
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005874 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005875 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5876 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005877 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005878 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
5879 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5880 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5881 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
5882 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
5883 Load Address: 0x00000000
5884 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005885
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005886
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005887Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
5888when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005889
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005890 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
5891 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
5892 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
5893 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5894 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
5895 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5896 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
5897 Load Address: 0x00000000
5898 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005899
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005900The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
5901option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
5902option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
5903from the image:
5904
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraf41f5b72015-01-15 02:54:40 -02005905 tools/dumpimage -i image -T type -p position data_file
5906 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file'
5907 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5908 -p ==> 'position' (starting at 0) of the 'data_file' inside the 'image'
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005909
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005910
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005911Installing a Linux Image:
5912-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005913
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005914To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
5915you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005916
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005917 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005918
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005919The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
5920image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
5921address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
5922specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
5923command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005924
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005925Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
5926TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005927
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005928 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005929
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005930 .......... done
5931 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005932
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005933 => loads 40100000
5934 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5935 ~>examples/image.srec
5936 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
5937 ...
5938 15989 15990 15991 15992
5939 [file transfer complete]
5940 [connected]
5941 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005942
5943
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005944You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005945this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005946corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005947
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005948 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005949
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005950 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5951 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5952 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5953 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5954 Load Address: 00000000
5955 Entry Point: 0000000c
5956 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005957
5958
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005959Boot Linux:
5960-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005961
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005962The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
5963memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
5964of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
5965parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
5966"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005967
5968
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005969 => printenv bootargs
5970 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005971
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005972 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005973
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005974 => printenv bootargs
5975 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005976
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005977 => bootm 40020000
5978 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
5979 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
5980 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5981 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
5982 Load Address: 00000000
5983 Entry Point: 0000000c
5984 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5985 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5986 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
5987 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
5988 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5989 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5990 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
5991 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005992
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005993If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005994the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
5995format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005996
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005997 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005998
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005999 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
6000 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
6001 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
6002 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
6003 Load Address: 00000000
6004 Entry Point: 0000000c
6005 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006006
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006007 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
6008 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
6009 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
6010 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
6011 Load Address: 00000000
6012 Entry Point: 00000000
6013 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006014
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006015 => bootm 40100000 40200000
6016 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
6017 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
6018 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
6019 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
6020 Load Address: 00000000
6021 Entry Point: 0000000c
6022 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6023 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
6024 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
6025 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
6026 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
6027 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
6028 Load Address: 00000000
6029 Entry Point: 00000000
6030 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6031 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
6032 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
6033 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
6034 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
6035 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
6036 ...
6037 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
6038 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006039
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006040 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006041
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006042Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
6043-----------
6044
6045First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
6046titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
6047following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
6048flat device tree:
6049
6050=> print oftaddr
6051oftaddr=0x300000
6052=> print oft
6053oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
6054=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
6055Speed: 1000, full duplex
6056Using TSEC0 device
6057TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
6058Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
6059Load address: 0x300000
6060Loading: #
6061done
6062Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
6063=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
6064Speed: 1000, full duplex
6065Using TSEC0 device
6066TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
6067Filename 'uImage'.
6068Load address: 0x200000
6069Loading:############
6070done
6071Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
6072=> print loadaddr
6073loadaddr=200000
6074=> print oftaddr
6075oftaddr=0x300000
6076=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
6077## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01006078 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
6079 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
6080 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006081 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01006082 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006083 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6084 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
6085Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
6086Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
6087Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
6088[snip]
6089
6090
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006091More About U-Boot Image Types:
6092------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006093
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006094U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006095
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006096 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
6097 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
6098 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
6099 the Standalone Program.
6100 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
6101 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
6102 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
6103 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
6104 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
6105 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
6106 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
6107 being started.
6108 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
6109 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
6110 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
6111 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
6112 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
6113 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006114
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006115 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
6116 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
6117 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
6118 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
6119 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
6120 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006121
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006122 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
6123 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
6124 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006125
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006126 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
6127 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
6128 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
6129 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006130
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00006131Booting the Linux zImage:
6132-------------------------
6133
6134On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
6135using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
6136as the syntax of "bootm" command.
6137
Tom Rini8ac28562013-05-16 11:40:11 -04006138Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00006139kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
6140address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
6141format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
6142
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006143
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006144Standalone HOWTO:
6145=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006146
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006147One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
6148run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
6149U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006150
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006151Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006152
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006153"Hello World" Demo:
6154-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006155
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006156'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
6157application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
6158It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
6159like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006160
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006161 => loads
6162 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6163 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
6164 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6165 [file transfer complete]
6166 [connected]
6167 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006168
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006169 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
6170 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6171 Hello World
6172 argc = 7
6173 argv[0] = "40004"
6174 argv[1] = "Hello"
6175 argv[2] = "World!"
6176 argv[3] = "This"
6177 argv[4] = "is"
6178 argv[5] = "a"
6179 argv[6] = "test."
6180 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
6181 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006182
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006183 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006184
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006185Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
6186handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
6187Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
6188The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
6189character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
6190controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006191
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006192 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
6193 b - enable interrupts and start timer
6194 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
6195 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006196
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006197 => loads
6198 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6199 ~>examples/timer.srec
6200 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6201 [file transfer complete]
6202 [connected]
6203 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006204
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006205 => go 40004
6206 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6207 TIMERS=0xfff00980
6208 Using timer 1
6209 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006210
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006211Hit 'b':
6212 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
6213 Enabling timer
6214Hit '?':
6215 [q, b, e, ?] ........
6216 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
6217Hit '?':
6218 [q, b, e, ?] .
6219 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
6220Hit '?':
6221 [q, b, e, ?] .
6222 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
6223Hit '?':
6224 [q, b, e, ?] .
6225 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
6226Hit 'e':
6227 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
6228Hit 'q':
6229 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006230
6231
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006232Minicom warning:
6233================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006234
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006235Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
6236"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
6237consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
6238Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
6239especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00006240use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
6241http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
6242for help with kermit.
6243
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006244
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006245Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
6246configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006247
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006248 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
6249 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
6250 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006251
6252
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006253NetBSD Notes:
6254=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006255
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006256Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
6257(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006258
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006259Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
6260NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
6261need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
6262Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
6263attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
6264missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006265
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006266 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
6267 # mkdir powerpc
6268 # ln -s powerpc machine
6269 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
6270 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006271
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006272Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
6273and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006274
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006275Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
6276stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
6277proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
6278tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00006279meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006280
6281
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006282Implementation Internals:
6283=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006284
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006285The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
6286implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
6287inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
6288hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006289
6290
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006291Initial Stack, Global Data:
6292---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006293
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006294The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
6295starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
6296system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
6297This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
6298is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
6299at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
6300options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
6301models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
6302MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
6303locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006304
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006305 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006306 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006307
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006308 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
6309 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
6310 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
6311 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006312
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006313 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
6314 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
6315 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
6316 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
6317 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006318 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006319 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
6320 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006322 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
6323 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006324 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006325 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
6326 board designers haven't used it for something that would
6327 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
6328 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006329
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006330 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006331 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
6332 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02006333 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006334 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
6335 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
6336 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
6337 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
6338 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006339
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006340 -Chris Hallinan
6341 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006342
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006343It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
6344code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006345
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006346* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
6347 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006348
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006349* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitly initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006350 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
6351 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006352
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006353* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
6354 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006356Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006357normal global data to share information between the code. But it
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006358turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
6359simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
6360functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
6361functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
6362the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
6363place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
6364reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006365
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006366When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
6367relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
6368GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006370For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
6371 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006372 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006373 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
6374 R5-R10: parameter passing
6375 R13: small data area pointer
6376 R30: GOT pointer
6377 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006378
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01006379 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
6380 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
6381 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006382
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006383 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006384
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006385 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
6386 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
6387 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
6388 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
6389 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
6390 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006391
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006392On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006393 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
6394
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006395 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006396
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006397On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006398
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006399 R0: function argument word/integer result
6400 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006401 R9: platform specific
6402 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006403 R11: argument (frame) pointer
6404 R12: temporary workspace
6405 R13: stack pointer
6406 R14: link register
6407 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006408
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006409 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
6410
6411 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006412
Thomas Chou0df01fd32010-05-21 11:08:03 +08006413On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
6414 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
6415
6416 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
6417
6418 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
6419 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
6420
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00006421On NDS32, the following registers are used:
6422
6423 R0-R1: argument/return
6424 R2-R5: argument
6425 R15: temporary register for assembler
6426 R16: trampoline register
6427 R28: frame pointer (FP)
6428 R29: global pointer (GP)
6429 R30: link register (LP)
6430 R31: stack pointer (SP)
6431 PC: program counter (PC)
6432
6433 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
6434
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02006435NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
6436or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006437
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006438Memory Management:
6439------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006441U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
6442MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006443
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006444The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
6445controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
6446memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
6447physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006448
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006449U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
6450TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
6451booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
6452to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006453memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006454configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
6455Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006456
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006457Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
6458of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006459
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006460So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
6461this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006462
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006463 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
6464 :
6465 0x0000 1FFF
6466 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
6467 :
6468 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006469
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006470 :
6471 :
6472 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
6473 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
6474 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
6475 :
6476 0x00FD FFFF
6477 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
6478 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
6479 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
6480 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006481
6482
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006483System Initialization:
6484----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006485
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006486In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006487(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006488configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the on board Flash memory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006489To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
6490To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
6491initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
6492which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
6493part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
6494the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006495
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006496Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
6497preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
6498(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
6499on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
6500programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
6501simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
6502banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006503
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006504When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
6505different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
6506bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
65070x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
6508contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006509
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006510Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
6511and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
6512Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
6513pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006514
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006515Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
6516until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
6517running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
6518new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006519
6520
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006521U-Boot Porting Guide:
6522----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006523
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006524[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
6525list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006526
6527
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006528int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006529{
6530 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006531
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006532 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
6533 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006534
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006535 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006536 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006537 return 0;
6538 }
6539
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006540 Download latest U-Boot source;
6541
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006542 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006543
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006544 if (clueless)
6545 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006546
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006547 while (learning) {
6548 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006549 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
6550 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006551 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006552 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006553 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006554
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006555 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
6556 Buy a BDI3000;
6557 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006558 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006559
6560 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
6561 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
6562 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
6563 } else {
6564 Create your own board support subdirectory;
6565 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006566 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006567 Edit new board/<myboard> files
6568 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006569
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006570 while (!accepted) {
6571 while (!running) {
6572 do {
6573 Add / modify source code;
6574 } until (compiles);
6575 Debug;
6576 if (clueless)
6577 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
6578 }
6579 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
6580 if (reasonable critiques)
6581 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
6582 else
6583 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006584 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006585
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006586 return 0;
6587}
6588
6589void no_more_time (int sig)
6590{
6591 hire_a_guru();
6592}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006593
6594
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006595Coding Standards:
6596-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006597
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006598All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006599coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006600"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006601
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006602Source files originating from a different project (for example the
6603MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006604reformatted to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006605sources.
6606
6607Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
6608Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
6609in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006610
6611Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
6612- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006613- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006614- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006615- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006616- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
6617
6618Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
6619with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006620
6621
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006622Submitting Patches:
6623-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006624
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006625Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
6626establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
6627may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006628
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02006629Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006630
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006631Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
6632see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
6633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006634When you send a patch, please include the following information with
6635it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006636
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006637* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
6638 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
6639 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006640
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006641* For new features: a description of the feature and your
6642 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006643
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006644* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
6645
6646* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
6647
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +02006648* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
6649 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006650
6651* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
6652 document these in the README file.
6653
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006654* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
6655 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006656 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006657 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
6658 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006659
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006660 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
6661 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
6662 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006663
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006664 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
6665 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
6666 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
6667 affected files).
6668
6669 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
6670 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006671
6672* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
6673 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
6674
6675* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
6676 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
6677
6678
6679Notes:
6680
6681* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
6682 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
6683 for any of the boards.
6684
6685* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
6686 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
6687 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
6688
6689* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
6690 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
6691 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
6692 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
6693 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
6694 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00006695
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006696* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
6697 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
6698 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
6699 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.